《我的世界》(Minecraft)是一款沙盒類電子游戲,開創(chuàng)者為馬庫(kù)斯·阿列克謝·泊松(Notch)。游戲由Mojang Studios維護(hù),現(xiàn)隸屬于微軟Xbox游戲工作室。
1. 我的世界nei mod這是NEI物品管理器MOD,加了這個(gè)MOD之后就會(huì)出現(xiàn)物品圖鑒以及合成表等。 2. 我的世界nei1.12中文:我要睡覺(jué)了 日語(yǔ):私は寢るの 音譯:wa da xi wa nei li yo 常用日語(yǔ) 1、はじめまして。 初次見(jiàn)面。 2、どうぞよろしく。 請(qǐng)多關(guān)照。 3、よろしくお愿(ねが)いします。 請(qǐng)多關(guān)照。 4、こちらこそよろしくお愿(ねが)いします。 也請(qǐng)您多關(guān)照。 5、自己(じこ)紹介(しょうかい)いたします。 我來(lái)自我介紹一下。 6、これはわたしの名刺(めいし)です。 這是我的名片。 7、わたしは李(り)と申(もう)します。 我姓李。 8、山田(やまだ)さんでいらっしゃいますね。 您是山田先生吧! 9、私(わたし)は山田(やまだ)です。 我是山田。 10、あのかたはどなたですか。 那位是誰(shuí)? 11、こちらは社長(zhǎng)(しゃちょう)の松本(まつもと)です。 這是我們總經(jīng)理松本。 12、彼(かれ)は中國(guó)人(ちゅうごくじん)ではありませんか。 他不是中國(guó)人嗎? 13、彼(かれ)は中國(guó)人(ちゅうごくじん)ではありません。 他不是中國(guó)人。 14、彼(かれ)は日本人(にほんじん)です。 他是日本人。 15、あなたも日本人(にほんじん)ですか。 你也是日本人嗎? 16、そうですか。 是嗎? 17、はい。 是的。 18、そうです。 是那樣的(是的)。 19、いいえ。 不對(duì)(不是)。 20、そうではありません。 不是那樣的(不是)。 3. 我的世界nei下載1.12.2如果只是要顯示名字,有NEI就可以,1、是按小鍵盤的“0”鍵,就會(huì)在屏幕上面的中央顯示一個(gè)文字框。 2、顯示所指向的方塊的名字。如果要顯示某些mod方塊的具體信息,比如ic存電箱里的電量,rc水槽里的液體存量等等,就需要再下載個(gè)waila的擴(kuò)展mod,wailaNBT。 4. 我的世界nei拼音搜索nei二聲的漢字是一個(gè)21筆畫的生僻字。 漢字(拼音:hàn zì,注音符號(hào):ㄏㄢˋ ㄗˋ),又稱中文、中國(guó)字、方塊字,是漢語(yǔ)的記錄符號(hào),屬于表意文字的詞素音節(jié)文字。世界上最古老的文字之一,已有六千多年的歷史。在形體上逐漸由圖形變?yōu)楣P畫,象形變?yōu)橄笳鳎瑥?fù)雜變?yōu)楹?jiǎn)單;在造字原則上從表形、表意到形聲。除極個(gè)別漢字外(如瓩、兛、兣、呎、嗧等),都是一個(gè)漢字一個(gè)音節(jié)。需要注意的是,日本、韓國(guó)、朝鮮、越南等國(guó)在歷史上都深受漢文化的影響,甚至其語(yǔ)文都存在借用漢語(yǔ)言文字的現(xiàn)象 5. 我的世界nei搜索【原來(lái)如此】的意思 發(fā)音應(yīng)該是sao dei si nei (此處為中文諧音) 6. nevada我的世界完整版nevada摩托車:意大利摩托車品牌,也是最富有傳統(tǒng)精神的摩托車品牌之一,屬于意大利莫托古茲公司旗下品牌。 1921年3月,卡羅·古茲和喬治·帕羅迪在美麗的科摩湖東畔創(chuàng)建了莫托古茲摩車公司。后來(lái)莫托古茲公司又開發(fā)了聞名遐邇的nevada系列,該車首次采用了彈性車體,并很快被世界上所有的摩托車生產(chǎn)商采用。 7. 我的世界nei安裝教程為什么這個(gè)幻燈片背景不能修改?如何取消幻燈片的自動(dòng)播放?……這些問(wèn)題經(jīng)常被職場(chǎng)小白問(wèn)起。這篇適合PPT小白快速入門的實(shí)用教程,目的是讓讀者學(xué)會(huì)、掌握、應(yīng)用PPT,達(dá)到知其然并知其所以然。 了解PPT 初識(shí)PPT PPT是Office辦公組件中的一個(gè)軟件。使用PPT創(chuàng)作的文件叫演示文稿,可以在投影儀或電腦上進(jìn)行播放,也可將演示文稿打印出來(lái),供他人瀏覽閱讀。 一般情況下,大眾喜愛(ài)的PPT通常都有一些相同的特點(diǎn):內(nèi)容準(zhǔn)確清晰,版式簡(jiǎn)潔大方,動(dòng)畫則恰到好處。 1、內(nèi)容準(zhǔn)確清晰。PPT主要負(fù)責(zé)傳遞信息,所以需要嚴(yán)密的邏輯框架作為支撐。因此,通過(guò)看PPT的內(nèi)容邏輯是否準(zhǔn)確、清晰,就可以判斷PPT是好還是壞。 2、版式簡(jiǎn)潔大方。PPT是用來(lái)傳達(dá)觀點(diǎn)的,所以不需要制作得太過(guò)復(fù)雜。一些初學(xué)者喜歡將各種各樣的元素都放入PPT中,結(jié)果作品的效果卻不盡如人意,觀眾也很難在雜亂無(wú)章的版式中獲取演講者所要表達(dá)的觀點(diǎn)。 3、動(dòng)畫恰到好處。在PPT中恰到好處的動(dòng)畫會(huì)起到錦上添花的作用,多余復(fù)雜的動(dòng)畫則容易喧賓奪主。 了解PPT的結(jié)構(gòu) 一、PPT的操作界面 PPT的操作界面主要包括標(biāo)題欄、功能區(qū)、編輯區(qū)、文件菜單、視圖區(qū)和狀態(tài)欄。 1、標(biāo)題欄。標(biāo)題欄位于頁(yè)面的最頂部,從左至右依次是快速訪問(wèn)工具欄、演示文稿名稱、登錄按鈕、功能區(qū)顯示選項(xiàng)按鈕、最小化按鈕、最大化按鈕和關(guān)閉按鈕。 2、功能區(qū)。功能區(qū)位于標(biāo)題欄下方,默認(rèn)包含8個(gè)選項(xiàng)卡,每個(gè)選項(xiàng)卡中包含多個(gè)選項(xiàng)組,相同類別的命令通常集中在同一個(gè)選項(xiàng)組中。同一個(gè)選項(xiàng)卡中包含的命令按鈕也屬于同一種類型。 下面詳細(xì)介紹一下各選項(xiàng)卡的功能。 (1)“開始”選項(xiàng)卡。該選項(xiàng)卡中包括“剪貼板”“幻燈片”“字體”“段落”“繪圖”和“編輯”6個(gè)選項(xiàng)組。在此,用戶可以新建幻燈片,設(shè)置幻燈片的文本、段落以及樣式等。 (2)“插入”選項(xiàng)卡。該選項(xiàng)卡包括“幻燈片”“表格”“圖像”“插圖”“加載項(xiàng)”“鏈接”“批注”“文本”“符號(hào)”及“媒體”選項(xiàng)組。在此,用戶可以在幻燈片中插入各種表格、圖片、超鏈接、文本框、公式、音像等元素。 (3)“設(shè)計(jì)”選項(xiàng)卡。該選項(xiàng)卡包括:“主題”“變體”“自定義”選項(xiàng)組。在此,用戶可以對(duì)幻燈片的大小、背景格式等進(jìn)行設(shè)置。 (4)“切換”選項(xiàng)卡。該選項(xiàng)卡包括“預(yù)覽”“切換到此幻燈片”“計(jì)時(shí)”選項(xiàng)組。在此,用戶可以為幻燈片設(shè)置各種切換效果。 (5)“動(dòng)畫”選項(xiàng)卡。該選項(xiàng)卡包括“預(yù)覽”“動(dòng)畫”“高級(jí)動(dòng)畫”和“計(jì)時(shí)”選項(xiàng)組。在此,用戶可以為其文本、圖片等添加各種動(dòng)畫效果。 (6)“幻燈片放映”選項(xiàng)卡。該選項(xiàng)卡包括“開始放映幻燈片”“設(shè)置”“監(jiān)視器”選項(xiàng)組。在此,用戶可以對(duì)幻燈片的放映參數(shù)進(jìn)行設(shè)置。 (7)“審閱”選項(xiàng)卡。該選項(xiàng)卡包括“校對(duì)”“語(yǔ)言”“比較”“墨跡”選項(xiàng)組。在此,用戶可以對(duì)文字進(jìn)行批注、檢索、字體的簡(jiǎn)繁轉(zhuǎn)換等。 (8)“視圖”選項(xiàng)卡。該選項(xiàng)卡包括“演示文稿視圖”“母版視圖”“顯示”“顯示比例”“窗口”和“宏”選項(xiàng)組。在此,用戶可以設(shè)置幻燈片的視圖模式、顯示標(biāo)尺和網(wǎng)格線等。 3、編輯區(qū)。編輯區(qū)位于整個(gè)頁(yè)面的中心位置,是演示文稿的工作區(qū)域。用戶可以在編輯區(qū)內(nèi)輸入文字、插入圖片、繪制圖形等。編輯區(qū)的顯示比例可以根據(jù)需要自由放大或縮小。 4、“文件”菜單。單擊界面左上角的“文件”菜單按鈕,可以打開“文件”菜單,該菜單中包含“信息”“新建”“打開”“保存”“另存為”“打印”“共享”“導(dǎo)出”“關(guān)閉”“帳戶”等12個(gè)選項(xiàng)。 5、狀態(tài)欄。狀態(tài)欄位于界面最底部,從左到右依次顯示的命令有“幻燈片頁(yè)數(shù)”“當(dāng)前顯示頁(yè)碼”“拼寫檢索”按鈕、“語(yǔ)言”“備注”按鈕、“批注”按鈕、“視圖”按鈕、“幻燈片放映”按鈕、“視圖縮放欄”等。 二、完整的PPT構(gòu)成 一份完整的PPT包含5部分,分別為標(biāo)題頁(yè)、目錄頁(yè)、過(guò)渡頁(yè)、內(nèi)容頁(yè)和結(jié)尾頁(yè),下面將分別對(duì)其進(jìn)行詳細(xì)介紹。 1、標(biāo)題頁(yè)。標(biāo)題頁(yè)決定觀眾的第一印象,如果標(biāo)題頁(yè)設(shè)計(jì)不好,則很難吸引觀眾的眼球。標(biāo)題頁(yè)可以是圖片+文字的形式,也可以是純文字形式。 (1)圖片+文字。以圖片為主的標(biāo)題頁(yè),具有較強(qiáng)的感染力,如果再加上富有震撼力的標(biāo)題文字,那就更容易吸引觀眾的視線了。這種形式的標(biāo)題頁(yè)需要注意的一個(gè)問(wèn)題是所選的圖片一定要是高清圖片。 (2)純文字。純文字的標(biāo)題頁(yè),需要考慮排版問(wèn)題。建議初學(xué)者盡量不要嘗試。有時(shí)為了避免頁(yè)面版式空洞,可以適當(dāng)添加一些形狀來(lái)修飾。 2、目錄頁(yè)。一般情況下,目錄頁(yè)緊隨標(biāo)題頁(yè)之后。目錄頁(yè)可讓觀眾了解PPT的大致內(nèi)容。目錄頁(yè)的表現(xiàn)形式有多種,下面將分別對(duì)其進(jìn)行介紹。 (1)利用形狀。目錄頁(yè)簡(jiǎn)潔明了,能突出重點(diǎn)即可,所以使用形狀是不錯(cuò)的選擇。 (2)利用PNG圖標(biāo)。使用圖標(biāo),可以幫助觀眾更好地記憶內(nèi)容,并且看起來(lái)簡(jiǎn)潔清爽,不會(huì)喧賓奪主。 (3)利用圖片。將目錄與圖片結(jié)合起來(lái),能有效打破頁(yè)面的平淡無(wú)奇,給人眼前一亮的感覺(jué)。 3、過(guò)渡頁(yè)。如果PPT的頁(yè)數(shù)較多,可以在其中添加過(guò)渡頁(yè),這樣可以給觀眾一個(gè)短暫的休息時(shí)間。當(dāng)然如果PPT的頁(yè)數(shù)較少,就沒(méi)有必要添加了,可以根據(jù)實(shí)際情況而定。 4、內(nèi)容頁(yè)。內(nèi)容頁(yè)是整個(gè)PPT中必不可少的,也是最重要的一部分,多以圖文結(jié)合的頁(yè)面形式來(lái)傳達(dá)內(nèi)容。 5、結(jié)尾頁(yè)。結(jié)束頁(yè)可以寫一些激勵(lì)性或感謝性的文字,或是表達(dá)美好祝愿的話語(yǔ)。同時(shí)要注意與PPT的整體風(fēng)格相呼應(yīng)。 三、PPT與幻燈片的關(guān)系 PPT又叫演示文稿,格式后綴為.ppt、.pptx。演示文稿中的每一頁(yè)就叫幻燈片,每張幻燈片都是演示文稿中既相互獨(dú)立又相互聯(lián)系的內(nèi)容。 PPT的基本操作 對(duì)PPT結(jié)構(gòu)有所了解后,接下來(lái)就要了解一下PPT的基本操作了。PPT的基本操作包括創(chuàng)建演示文稿、保存演示文稿、打開和關(guān)閉演示文稿、查看演示文稿等,下面分別對(duì)其進(jìn)行詳細(xì)介紹。 1、輕松創(chuàng)建文稿 創(chuàng)建PPT的方法有多種,下面以創(chuàng)建模板PPT為例,向用戶介紹具體的操作方法。 步驟1:雙擊PowerPoint應(yīng)用程序快捷圖標(biāo),啟動(dòng)軟件,在打開界面右側(cè)的搜索框中輸入需要搜索模板的類型,然后單擊“開始搜索”按鈕。 步驟2:隨即在新建界面中顯示出所有搜索到的模板,單擊選擇需要的模板。 步驟3:彈出模板詳情窗口,接著單擊“創(chuàng)建”按鈕。 步驟4:系統(tǒng)開始下載該模板,下載完成后會(huì)自動(dòng)打開該模板,即可創(chuàng)建一個(gè)模板PPT。 2、保存與另存為 在創(chuàng)建演示文稿后,需要將其保存,以免因?yàn)橐馔鈹嚯娀螂娔X死機(jī),而造成文件內(nèi)容丟失。在創(chuàng)建演示文稿后,如果用戶是第一次執(zhí)行保存操作,則可以按照以下方法進(jìn)行保存。 步驟1:在演示文稿界面,單擊“文件”菜單按鈕。 步驟2:在打開的“文件”菜單窗口中選擇“另存為”選項(xiàng),在右側(cè)選擇“瀏覽”選項(xiàng)。 步驟3:打開“另存為”對(duì)話框,從中選擇保存的位置,修改“文件名”,單擊“保存”按鈕。 步驟4:返回演示文稿,此時(shí)可以看到,標(biāo)題欄中即顯示修改后的演示文稿的名稱。當(dāng)用戶執(zhí)行保存操作后,若對(duì)演示文稿進(jìn)行了修改和編輯,直接單擊“保存”按鈕即可對(duì)其保存。 3、打開與關(guān)閉操作 打開演示文稿的操作方法其實(shí)很簡(jiǎn)單,除了雙擊文件圖標(biāo)外,還可以按照以下幾種方法進(jìn)行操作。 (1)右鍵打開法。打開文件所在的文件夾,單擊選中需要打開的演示文稿,然后單擊鼠標(biāo)右鍵,從彈出的快捷菜單中選擇“打開”命令,即可打開所選的演示文稿。 (2)打開計(jì)算機(jī)中的演示文稿。還可以利用已打開的演示文稿選擇計(jì)算機(jī)中的其他演示文稿,具體操作如下: 步驟1:在打開的演示文稿中單擊“文件”菜單按鈕。(也可以通過(guò)Ctrl+O快捷鍵打開計(jì)算機(jī)中的演示文稿,這種方法更加方便快捷。) 步驟2:進(jìn)入“文件”菜單,選擇“打開”選項(xiàng),并在右側(cè)選擇“瀏覽”選項(xiàng)。 步驟3:彈出“打開”對(duì)話框,選中需要打開的演示文稿,然后單擊“打開”按鈕,即可打開選中的演示文稿。 4、查看演示文稿 在制作完演示文稿后,為了確保內(nèi)容的準(zhǔn)確性,可以對(duì)演示文稿中的內(nèi)容進(jìn)行查看。 (1)普通視圖。在普通視圖下,將光標(biāo)移到編輯區(qū)上方,滑動(dòng)鼠標(biāo)滾輪可以對(duì)幻燈片的內(nèi)容進(jìn)行查看,或者將光標(biāo)放在右側(cè)的滑塊上,拖動(dòng)鼠標(biāo)查看PPT中的內(nèi)容。 (2)幻燈片瀏覽。在狀態(tài)欄中單擊“幻燈片瀏覽”按鈕,可在瀏覽模式中對(duì)演示文稿中所有幻燈片進(jìn)行查看。 (3)閱讀視圖。在狀態(tài)欄中單擊“閱讀視圖”按鈕,即可進(jìn)入放映預(yù)覽狀態(tài),在這種狀態(tài)下,用戶可以對(duì)幻燈片中的內(nèi)容和動(dòng)畫效果進(jìn)行查看。 幻燈片的基本操作 前面介紹了演示文稿的基本操作,接下來(lái)學(xué)習(xí)一下幻燈片的基本操作,包括選擇幻燈片、新建幻燈片、移動(dòng)與復(fù)制幻燈片、隱藏與刪除幻燈片、更改幻燈片的背景等。 一、選擇幻燈片 1、選擇單個(gè)幻燈片。如果想選擇單個(gè)幻燈片,則只需在預(yù)覽區(qū)域單擊所需幻燈片,即可將其選中。 2、選擇不連續(xù)的幻燈片。按住Ctrl鍵不放,在預(yù)覽區(qū)域中依次用鼠標(biāo)單擊多個(gè)幻燈片,即可將不連續(xù)的幻燈片選中。 3、選擇連續(xù)的幻燈片。按住Shift鍵,在預(yù)覽區(qū)域中單擊任意兩個(gè)不相鄰的幻燈片,即可將它們之間的所有幻燈片選中。 4、選擇全部幻燈片。首先單擊預(yù)覽區(qū)域中任意幻燈片,然后按Ctrl+A組合鍵,即可將全部幻燈片選中。 二、新建幻燈片 若演示文稿中的幻燈片太少,不能滿足編輯需求,則用戶可以在演示文稿中新建幻燈片。 步驟1:打開演示文稿,選中任意一張幻燈片,在“開始”選項(xiàng)卡中單擊“新建幻燈片”下拉按鈕,從列表中選擇“空白”選項(xiàng)。 步驟2:被選中的幻燈片下方隨即新建一個(gè)“空白”版式的幻燈片。 步驟3:若在下拉列表中選擇“兩欄內(nèi)容”選項(xiàng)。 步驟4:即可新建“兩欄內(nèi)容”版式的幻燈片。 注:還可以通過(guò)右鍵菜單功能來(lái)新建幻燈片,即選擇任意幻燈片,單擊鼠標(biāo)右鍵,從彈出的快捷菜單中選擇“新建幻燈片”命令,即可新建—個(gè)幻燈片。 三、移動(dòng)與復(fù)制幻燈片 在編輯演示文稿的過(guò)程中,如果覺(jué)得幻燈片的順序不合理,可以移動(dòng)幻燈片來(lái)調(diào)整其順序。若需要添加相同格式的幻燈片,則可以復(fù)制幻燈片,下面將介紹幾種移動(dòng)與復(fù)制幻燈片的方法。 1、移動(dòng)幻燈片。可以按照以下幾種方法移動(dòng)幻燈片: (1)功能區(qū)按鈕移動(dòng) 步驟1:選擇需要移動(dòng)的幻燈片,在“開始”選項(xiàng)卡中單擊“剪切”按鈕。 步驟2:將光標(biāo)定位至需要移動(dòng)到的位置,單擊“粘貼”下拉按鈕,從列表中選擇“使用目標(biāo)主題”選項(xiàng)。 步驟3:隨即將所選幻燈片移動(dòng)到目標(biāo)位置。 (2)鼠標(biāo)拖動(dòng)移動(dòng) 步驟1:選擇需要的幻燈片,然后按住鼠標(biāo)左鍵不放,拖動(dòng)鼠標(biāo)至合適位置。 步驟2:釋放鼠標(biāo)左鍵,即可完成幻燈片的移動(dòng)。 2、復(fù)制幻燈片 若用戶想要添加相同格式的幻燈片,則可以利用復(fù)制功能來(lái)實(shí)現(xiàn),下面介紹幾種復(fù)制幻燈片的方法。 (1)功能區(qū)按鈕復(fù)制 步驟1:選擇需要復(fù)制的幻燈片,在“開始”選項(xiàng)卡中單擊“復(fù)制”按鈕。 步驟2:在需要粘貼的位置插入光標(biāo),單擊“粘貼”下拉按鈕,從列表中選擇“使用目標(biāo)主題”選項(xiàng)即可。 步驟3:此時(shí)在該位置可顯示所復(fù)制的幻燈片。 (2)右鍵快捷菜單復(fù)制 選擇幻燈片后,單擊鼠標(biāo)右鍵,從彈出的快捷菜單中選擇“復(fù)制幻燈片”命令即可。 (3)鼠標(biāo)+鍵盤復(fù)制 選擇需要復(fù)制的幻燈片,并按住鼠標(biāo)左鍵不放,接著在鍵盤上按住Ctrl鍵,然后拖動(dòng)鼠標(biāo)至合適位置,釋放鼠標(biāo)左鍵后松開Ctrl鍵,即可復(fù)制選擇的幻燈片。 四、隱藏與顯示幻燈片 如果不想播放某張幻燈片,但又不想將其刪除,則可以將該幻燈片隱藏起來(lái)。 步驟1:選擇需要隱藏的幻燈片,這里選擇第2張幻燈片,切換至“幻燈片放映”選項(xiàng)卡,單擊“隱藏幻燈片”按鈕。 步驟2:此時(shí),可以看到所選幻燈片的左上角出現(xiàn)了隱藏符號(hào)。如果想要顯示隱藏的幻燈片,則需要再次單擊“隱藏幻燈片”按鈕,即可將隱藏的幻燈片顯示出來(lái)。 注:還可以通過(guò)右鍵菜單來(lái)隱藏幻燈片,即選擇需要隱藏的幻燈片,單擊鼠標(biāo)右鍵,從彈出的快捷菜單中選擇“隱藏幻燈片”命令,即可將選擇的幻燈片隱藏起來(lái)。 五、刪除幻燈片 當(dāng)演示文稿中的幻燈片較多,有些內(nèi)容多余,想精減時(shí),可以將冗余的幻燈片刪除。下面介紹兩種刪除幻燈片的方法。 1、右鍵菜單法。選擇需要?jiǎng)h除的幻燈片,然后單擊鼠標(biāo)右鍵,從彈出的快捷菜單中選擇“刪除幻燈片”命令,即可將選擇的幻燈片刪除。 2、快捷鍵法。選擇需要?jiǎng)h除的幻燈片,然后直接在鍵盤上按Delete鍵,即可將所選幻燈片刪除。 六、調(diào)整幻燈片大小 默認(rèn)的幻燈片大小為寬屏(16:9),用戶也可以根據(jù)需要自定義幻燈片的大小,下面介紹具體的操作方法。 步驟1:選擇幻燈片,切換至“設(shè)計(jì)”選項(xiàng)卡,單擊“幻燈片大小”下拉按鈕,從中選擇“自定義幻燈片大小”選項(xiàng)。 步驟2:打開“幻燈片大小”對(duì)話框,在“幻燈片大小”下拉列表中選擇“自定義”選項(xiàng),設(shè)置“寬度”和“高度”值,單擊“確定”按鈕。 步驟3:彈出相應(yīng)的對(duì)話框,從中選擇“確保適合”選項(xiàng)。 步驟4:此時(shí),可以看到幻燈片的尺寸隨即被調(diào)整為自定義的大小。 注:也可以直接在“幻燈片大小”下拉列表中選擇“標(biāo)準(zhǔn)”選項(xiàng),快速更改幻燈片的大小。 七、更改幻燈片的背景 如果對(duì)當(dāng)前幻燈片的背景不滿意,可以對(duì)其進(jìn)行更改。具體操作方法如下: 步驟1:選擇幻燈片,在“設(shè)計(jì)”選項(xiàng)卡中單擊“設(shè)置背景格式”按鈕。 步驟2:彈出“設(shè)置背景格式”窗格,切換至“填充”選項(xiàng)卡,在“填充”組中選中“圖片或紋理填充”單選按鈕,接著單擊下方的“文件”按鈕。 步驟3:打開“插入圖片”對(duì)話框,選擇圖片后單擊“插入”按鈕。 步驟4:關(guān)閉窗格,此時(shí)可以看到幻燈片的背景更改為圖片背景的效果了。 版式設(shè)計(jì) 了解PPT的基本操作后,用戶可以制作出簡(jiǎn)單的演示文稿,但如果想制作出精美大氣的作品,則需要對(duì)版式進(jìn)行一番設(shè)計(jì)。本節(jié)將對(duì)PPT的版式設(shè)計(jì)、模板的運(yùn)用、PPT的配色等進(jìn)行全面介紹。 PPT版式設(shè)計(jì)原則 一、什么樣的頁(yè)面版式才好看 好看的頁(yè)面版式會(huì)遵循親近、對(duì)比、對(duì)齊和重復(fù)這4項(xiàng)原則。 1、親近 內(nèi)容上有關(guān)聯(lián)的要靠近,沒(méi)有關(guān)聯(lián)的要遠(yuǎn)離,同時(shí)要統(tǒng)一各段落的間隔。 2、對(duì)齊 各層之間要對(duì)齊,因?yàn)槊恳粋(gè)元素都與頁(yè)面上的某項(xiàng)內(nèi)容存在某種視覺(jué)聯(lián)系,如果隨意安放,則會(huì)顯得混亂。但頁(yè)面中有很多個(gè)關(guān)鍵字時(shí),打破對(duì)齊也能產(chǎn)生不一樣的視覺(jué)效果。 3、對(duì)比 對(duì)比的方法有3種:文字對(duì)比、顏色對(duì)比和圖形對(duì)比。通過(guò)對(duì)比可以迅速吸引觀眾的眼球。 下圖則通過(guò)圖形色塊來(lái)區(qū)分各項(xiàng)內(nèi)容。當(dāng)觀眾看到這張幻燈片內(nèi)容時(shí),會(huì)立即被黃色色塊的內(nèi)容吸引住。這里需要提醒一點(diǎn)的是,對(duì)比的力度一定要大,否則就不要用。 4、重復(fù) 通過(guò)讓PPT的部分元素,例如圖片、字體、配色等重復(fù)使用,可以使PPT的版式風(fēng)格統(tǒng)一,避免雜亂無(wú)章。但需要注意的是,不要一味地單調(diào)重復(fù),要明確每個(gè)頁(yè)面的作用。 (1)標(biāo)題頁(yè) (2)目錄頁(yè) (3)內(nèi)容頁(yè) (4)結(jié)尾頁(yè) 二、PPT中的留白藝術(shù) 留白留出的是空間。對(duì)于幻燈片而言,最直觀的好處就是用戶可以輕易地添加文字,保證文字信息不受干擾,和圖片一起傳遞信息。另外,留白具有與生俱來(lái)的雅致、高端、文藝、輕盈、簡(jiǎn)約氣質(zhì)。下面就向讀者介紹在PPT中人為留白的3種方法。 1、尋找簡(jiǎn)單的背景圖。盡量用簡(jiǎn)單的圖片作為幻燈片背景,然后添加與主題相關(guān)的關(guān)鍵字即可。當(dāng)然尋找的圖片也應(yīng)當(dāng)與主題相關(guān)才行。 2、利用形狀襯托關(guān)鍵字。利用精致的圖片作為背景,使用矩形覆蓋背景某區(qū)域,以作為文字的底襯,在矩形框中輸入文字即可。該矩形框可填充顏色,也可提高它的透明度。 3、減少頁(yè)面信息量。留出空白其實(shí)就是做減法。減去多余的,留出關(guān)鍵的信息即可。 三、頁(yè)面排版的4大利器 想要實(shí)現(xiàn)以上4項(xiàng)排版原則,則需要利用以下4種輔助工具來(lái)操作。 1、對(duì)齊。PPT為用戶提供了8種對(duì)齊方式。通過(guò)使用這些對(duì)齊方式,用戶可以快速完成頁(yè)面的布局,提高PPT排版效率,對(duì)齊的操作方法如下:: 步驟1:選擇需對(duì)齊的元素,這里選擇文本,切換至“繪圖工具-格式”選項(xiàng)卡,單擊“對(duì)齊”下拉按鈕,從列表中選擇“垂直居中”選項(xiàng)。 步驟2:此時(shí)可以看到,選中的文本已經(jīng)顯示為垂直居中。 步驟3:若在列表中選擇“右對(duì)齊”選項(xiàng),則選中的文本將向右對(duì)齊顯示。 2、組合。將多個(gè)對(duì)象組合在一起后,可以實(shí)現(xiàn)整體的快速移動(dòng),當(dāng)縮小或放大形狀組合時(shí),組合中的所有形狀的大小會(huì)同時(shí)發(fā)生改變,具體操作方法如下: 步驟1:選中圖形對(duì)象,單擊鼠標(biāo)右鍵,從彈出的快捷菜單中選擇“組合”選項(xiàng)。 步驟2:將形狀組合在一起后,按住Shift鍵不放,可以等比例放大或縮小圖形。 3、窗格。窗格可以通過(guò)單擊“繪圖工具-格式”選項(xiàng)卡中的“選擇窗格”按鈕打開,窗格的作用是調(diào)節(jié)各個(gè)元素的層次,對(duì)此也可以通過(guò)鼠標(biāo)拖動(dòng)來(lái)實(shí)現(xiàn),還可以通過(guò)單擊按鈕實(shí)現(xiàn)。此外,通過(guò)窗格還可以隱藏元素,單擊右側(cè)的眼睛圖標(biāo)即可隱藏。 4、網(wǎng)格與參考線。網(wǎng)格和參考線一般用來(lái)定位PPT中的各元素。兩者都是在編輯狀態(tài)下顯示,播放幻燈片時(shí)則會(huì)自動(dòng)隱藏。 如果需要調(diào)出網(wǎng)格或參考線的話,只需要在“視圖”選項(xiàng)卡中勾選“網(wǎng)格”或“參考線”選項(xiàng)即可。這兩個(gè)選項(xiàng)卡可以同時(shí)勾選,也可以只勾選其中一項(xiàng)。在對(duì)頁(yè)面進(jìn)行排版時(shí),只需勾選“參考線”這一項(xiàng)即可。在勾選參考線后,系統(tǒng)會(huì)在頁(yè)面中心位置分別顯示水平和垂直兩條參考線。 需要添加參考線的話,只需將光標(biāo)放置在參考線上,當(dāng)光標(biāo)變成雙向箭頭時(shí),點(diǎn)擊鼠標(biāo)右鍵,在彈出的快捷菜單中根據(jù)需要選擇“添加垂直參考線”或“添加水平參考線”選項(xiàng)即可。也可以為參考線更換顏色。同樣在參考線上點(diǎn)擊鼠標(biāo)右鍵,在快捷菜單中選擇“顏色”選項(xiàng),并在打開的級(jí)聯(lián)菜單中選擇一種顏色即可。 如果想要?jiǎng)h除參考線,只需在“視圖”選項(xiàng)卡中,取消勾選“參考線”選項(xiàng)即可。也可以在參考線上單擊鼠標(biāo)右鍵,在快捷菜單中選擇“刪除”選項(xiàng),即可刪除多余參考線。 用好PPT模板 如果用戶覺(jué)得自己制作模板比較耗時(shí),則可套用網(wǎng)上下載的模板,或者對(duì)現(xiàn)有模板進(jìn)行修改,符合要求后再使用。 一、如何挑選模板 網(wǎng)上有大量的模板,其中不乏精品,但選擇模板時(shí),一定要挑選合適的模板。這里將介紹挑選模板的3個(gè)原則。 1、符合公司形象。如果用戶展示的演示文稿代表整個(gè)公司,那么選擇的模板一定要符合公司的形象。一般會(huì)選擇嚴(yán)肅、大方的模板。 2、契合展示主題。選擇模板時(shí)要符合展示的主題,不同的主題對(duì)模板的要求不一樣。例如,如果主題是關(guān)于兒童教育的,就盡量用卡通類的,或者各種手繪風(fēng)格的模板。 3、讓人眼前一亮。用戶制作PPT除了輔助演講外,最重要的是吸引觀眾的注意力,所以制作的PPT要有特色,看起來(lái)讓人賞心悅目,這樣才能讓人眼前一亮。 注:可以通過(guò)PPT論壇、共享網(wǎng)站、PPT商店、PPT模板下載網(wǎng)站以及達(dá)人的博客或微博下載需要的PPT模板。需要提醒一點(diǎn)的是,下載模板時(shí)需弄清楚該模板是否可以商用。很多模板都存在版權(quán)問(wèn)題,用戶私下交流沒(méi)有關(guān)系,一旦涉及商用,就需繳納一定的版權(quán)費(fèi)了。 二、對(duì)模板進(jìn)行微調(diào) 一般情況下,模板下載完以后,都需要對(duì)其調(diào)整,畢竟沒(méi)有百分之百合適的模板。當(dāng)用戶需要對(duì)模板進(jìn)行調(diào)整時(shí),可以分3步操作:刪除、改變和添加。 1、刪除多余頁(yè)面或元素。刪除模板中一些多余的頁(yè)面,因?yàn)橛行╉?yè)面只是版面設(shè)計(jì)不同,而內(nèi)容是相同的,像這些頁(yè)面就需要?jiǎng)h除。 2、改變。可以改變幻燈片的大小、背景圖、配色、字體和版式設(shè)計(jì)等。首先,可以修改以下幻燈片的版式設(shè)計(jì)。其次,可以將標(biāo)題幻燈片中的文字進(jìn)行修改,例如修改其文字內(nèi)容、字體或字號(hào)等。 3、添加。如果現(xiàn)有的版式不能完全滿足需求,則可以另外添加一頁(yè)版式。用戶只需根據(jù)自己的需求簡(jiǎn)單調(diào)整即可。這樣做出來(lái)的PPT既快又好。想高效制作PPT,使用模板是最佳的選擇。 三、認(rèn)識(shí)幻燈片的母版 使用母版最大的好處在于,它可以快速統(tǒng)一幻燈片的風(fēng)格,例如文字、圖片、背景等。下面將詳細(xì)介紹母版的結(jié)構(gòu)和類型。 步驟1:打開演示文稿,切換至“視圖”選項(xiàng)卡,單擊“幻燈片母版”按鈕。 步驟2:進(jìn)入母版視圖后,在左側(cè)可以看到一組默認(rèn)的母版結(jié)構(gòu)。 步驟3:Office主題。該頁(yè)位于母版視圖的首位,也稱之為母版頁(yè)。在這一頁(yè)中添加的內(nèi)容會(huì)出現(xiàn)在以下所有版式頁(yè)中。 注:母版視圖是由母版頁(yè)和版式頁(yè)這兩個(gè)部分組成的。母版頁(yè)僅為第1張幻燈片,除此之外,所有的幻燈片都稱為版式頁(yè)。 步驟4:標(biāo)題幻燈片。可用于幻燈片的封面、封底設(shè)計(jì)。與母版頁(yè)不同時(shí),需要勾選隱藏背景圖形復(fù)選框。 步驟5:標(biāo)題和內(nèi)容。由標(biāo)題框架和內(nèi)容框架部分組成。 步驟6:此外,還有節(jié)標(biāo)題、兩欄內(nèi)容、比較、僅標(biāo)題、空白、內(nèi)容與標(biāo)題版式等。這些版式都可以根據(jù)設(shè)計(jì)需要重新調(diào)整。 四、修改幻燈片的母版 用戶可以在幻燈片母版中修改字體和版式,使幻燈片形成統(tǒng)一的風(fēng)格。具體操作步驟介紹如下: 步驟1:打開演示文稿,切換至“視圖”選項(xiàng)卡,單擊“幻燈片母版”按鈕。 步驟2:進(jìn)入母版視圖模式,然后選擇Office主題母版,并選中其中的標(biāo)題占位符。 步驟3:切換至“開始”選項(xiàng)卡,單擊“字體”下拉按鈕,從列表中選擇“漢儀行楷簡(jiǎn)”選項(xiàng)。 步驟4:?jiǎn)螕簟白痔?hào)”下拉按鈕,從列表中選擇“40”。 步驟5:按照同樣的方法,設(shè)置文本占位符中的字體、字號(hào)。 步驟6:切換至“幻燈片母版”選項(xiàng)卡,單擊“背景樣式”下拉按鈕,從列表中選擇“設(shè)置背景格式”選項(xiàng)。 步驟7:打開“設(shè)置背景格式”窗格,切換至“填充”選項(xiàng)卡,在“填充”組中選中“圖片或紋理填充”單選按鈕,并單擊“文件”按鈕。 步驟8:打開“插入圖片”對(duì)話框,從中選擇背景圖片后單擊“插入”按鈕。 步驟9:關(guān)閉窗格,切換至“插入”選項(xiàng)卡,單擊“圖片”按鈕。 步驟10:打開“插入圖片”對(duì)話框,選擇圖片后單擊“插入”按鈕。 步驟11:將圖片插入到母版中,調(diào)整圖片的大小,將其移至頁(yè)面合適位置。 步驟12:按照同樣的方法,插入另外—張圖片,然后將其移至合適位置。 步驟13:選中標(biāo)題幻燈片,在“背景”選項(xiàng)組中勾選“隱藏背景圖形”復(fù)選框。 步驟14:隱藏圖形后,為其填充背景圖片。在“插入”選項(xiàng)卡中單擊“圖片”按鈕。 步驟15:打開“插入圖片”對(duì)話框,選擇圖片后單擊“插入”按鈕。 步驟16:插入圖片后調(diào)整圖片的大小,并將其移至頁(yè)面合適位置。 步驟17:?jiǎn)螕簟盎脽羝赴妗边x項(xiàng)卡中的“關(guān)閉母版視圖”按鈕,查看設(shè)置的效果。 用好的配色裝扮PPT PPT中的顏色很重要,一個(gè)頁(yè)面色彩靚麗且配色舒適的PPT很容易就能抓往觀眾的眼球。當(dāng)然也不能胡亂的運(yùn)用色彩,下面將介紹關(guān)于配色方面的知識(shí),為設(shè)計(jì)PPT的版式打好基礎(chǔ)。 一、幾種安全配色模式 1、灰底單色搭配。使用灰色作為背景色,和其他單一顏色進(jìn)行搭配。灰色可以營(yíng)造出精致、含蓄的氛圍。 2、白底單色搭配。白色是百搭色,使用白色作為背景色,可以和任意顏色進(jìn)行搭配。白色給人一種清爽、干凈的感覺(jué)。 3、同色系明暗搭配。嘗試使用同一種色相、不同明度的顏色進(jìn)行搭配。這種方法比較簡(jiǎn)單和安全。 4、只用單一背景色。有時(shí)使用單一的背景色加上幾個(gè)關(guān)鍵字或圖片,也能起到很好的效果。 二、取色器的使用秘訣 使用取色器可以將其他PPT中的配色提取并運(yùn)用到自己的PPT中,也可以從圖片中快速提取出需要的顏色。下面將為大家介紹具體的操作方法: 步驟1:選中需要填充顏色的圖形,切換至“繪圖工具-格式”選項(xiàng)卡,單擊“形狀填充”下拉按鈕,從列表中選擇“取色器”選項(xiàng)。 步驟2:此時(shí),鼠標(biāo)光標(biāo)變?yōu)槲苄螤睿瑢⑺苿?dòng)到想要填充的色塊上,在吸管右側(cè)會(huì)顯示該色塊的色值。 步驟3:確認(rèn)后單擊鼠標(biāo)左鍵,即可將選取的顏色快速填充到圖形中。 注:在電腦系統(tǒng)中,R、G、B分別代表著紅色、綠色和藍(lán)色,這3種顏色的值均用0-255的整數(shù)來(lái)表示。例如,純紅色的色值為(255,0,0),純綠色的色值為(0.255,0),而純藍(lán)色的色值為(0.,0.255)。用戶只要在“顏色”對(duì)話框的“顏色模式”選項(xiàng)組下設(shè)置這些色值參數(shù)即可,在默認(rèn)情況下“顏色模式”為“RGB“。 學(xué)會(huì)運(yùn)用PPT主題 前面介紹了創(chuàng)建模板演示文稿,其實(shí)使用主題創(chuàng)建演示文稿也是一種不錯(cuò)的選擇,這樣可以免去用戶自己設(shè)計(jì)主題的麻煩。 一、使用主題創(chuàng)建PPT 使用主題創(chuàng)建演示文稿的方法和創(chuàng)建模板演示文稿相似,具體的操作步驟如下: 步驟1:?jiǎn)?dòng)PowerPoint,在打開界面的右側(cè)單擊“主題”按鈕。 步驟2:在搜索到的主題中選擇合適的選項(xiàng)。 步驟3:?jiǎn)螕粼撨x項(xiàng),將彈出一個(gè)窗格,然后直接單擊“創(chuàng)建”按鈕。 步驟4:系統(tǒng)開始下載該主題演示文稿,下載完成后會(huì)自動(dòng)打開演示文稿。 二、修改主題樣式 如果對(duì)默認(rèn)的主題樣式不滿意,可以對(duì)主題的顏色、字體、背景等進(jìn)行修改,下面介紹具體的操作方法: 步驟1:修改主題顏色。切換至“設(shè)計(jì)”選項(xiàng)卡,單擊“變體”選項(xiàng)組中的“其他”按鈕,從列表中選擇“顏色”選項(xiàng),并從其級(jí)聯(lián)菜單中選擇合適的顏色。 步驟2:修改主題字體。單擊“變體”選項(xiàng)組中的“其他”按鈕,從列表中選擇“字體”選項(xiàng),并從其級(jí)聯(lián)菜單中選擇合適的字體。 步驟3:修改主題背景樣式。單擊“變體”選項(xiàng)組中的“其他”按鈕,從列表中選擇“背景樣式”選項(xiàng),并從其級(jí)聯(lián)菜單中選擇“設(shè)置背景格式”選項(xiàng)。 步驟4:修改主題背景樣式。單擊“變體”選項(xiàng)組中的“其他”按鈕,從列表中選擇“背景樣式”選項(xiàng),并從其級(jí)聯(lián)菜單中選擇“設(shè)置背景格式”選項(xiàng)。 步驟5:在“設(shè)置背景格式”窗格中單擊“應(yīng)用到全部”按鈕。 步驟6:?jiǎn)螕簟瓣P(guān)閉”按鈕,關(guān)閉窗格,查看修改主題背景樣式的效果。(注:可以在“設(shè)計(jì)”選項(xiàng)卡中單擊“主題”選項(xiàng)組中的“其他”按鈕,從列表中可以直接更改當(dāng)前演示文稿的主題。) 主題模板與模板的區(qū)別:主題模板可以統(tǒng)一更改顏色、背景,而模板則不可以。 字體搭配 制作演示文稿的目的是為了展示內(nèi)容,傳達(dá)觀點(diǎn),所以文本是演示文稿中不可或缺的,并且在幻燈片中輸入文本后還要對(duì)其進(jìn)行各種設(shè)置。本節(jié)將對(duì)文字的選擇、文本的輸入、文本的編輯、文本段落的設(shè)置等操作進(jìn)行全面介紹。 文字的選擇有講究 字體是演示文稿中必不可少的一個(gè)元素,要想制作出優(yōu)秀的演示文稿,選擇一種合適的字體很重要。 一、選擇合適的字體 一般用戶會(huì)使用PPT中默認(rèn)的字體,這樣制作出來(lái)的PPT看起來(lái)千篇一律。其實(shí)選擇一種合適的字體,會(huì)起到不—樣的效果,用戶可以根據(jù)不同場(chǎng)合使用不同的字體。 1、普通字體。PPT中用到的絕大多數(shù)字體都可歸為普通字體。例如,微軟雅黑、黑體、華文行楷、漢儀系列等,目前大多數(shù)的PPT都經(jīng)常使用這類字體。 2、鋼筆字體。在PPT中使用鋼筆字體,例如方正硬筆行書簡(jiǎn)體、方正硬筆楷書簡(jiǎn)體等,可以使PPT充滿文藝感。這類字體比較適合教育、書籍、文化等領(lǐng)域相關(guān)主題內(nèi)容。 3、書法字體。書法字體很常見(jiàn),例如日本青柳衡山毛筆字體、段寧毛筆行書、葉根友系列字體等,這類字體適合中國(guó)風(fēng)、水墨風(fēng)的PPT。 4、卡通字體。卡通字體在視覺(jué)上非常可愛(ài),例如華康娃娃體、方正卡通簡(jiǎn)體、方正胖頭魚簡(jiǎn)體、漢儀樂(lè)窯體等,這類字體適合兒童教學(xué)課件或與兒童相關(guān)的主題。 5、英文字體。前面幾種類型均為中文字體,但在制作PPT時(shí)還會(huì)用到英文,那英文字體該怎么選呢?這里將推薦幾款常用英文字體,供用戶參考。 (1)TimesNewRoman。該字體是系統(tǒng)自帶的英文字體,適合歷史文化類PPT。 (2)Tahoma。該字體也是系統(tǒng)自帶的字體,給人一種親切感,在一定程度上可以調(diào)節(jié)現(xiàn)場(chǎng)氛圍。 (3)SegoeUILight。該字體比較纖細(xì),使用該字體可以使整個(gè)PPT看起來(lái)清新自然。 (4)PalaceScriptMT。該字體是裝飾性很強(qiáng)的手寫體,一般用于文藝、請(qǐng)?zhí)⒐?jié)日等主題。 提示:在一張幻燈片中,如果中英文同時(shí)存在,那么英文字體就要根據(jù)中文字體來(lái)調(diào)整,也就是說(shuō)兩種字體要相互匹配。另外,字體也有版權(quán)如果用戶將下載的字體用于商業(yè)用途,則需要支付版權(quán)費(fèi)。 二、安裝字體的方法 如果用戶在網(wǎng)上下載了幾款字體,想要進(jìn)行安裝,可以按照以下幾種方法進(jìn)行操作: 1、復(fù)制和粘貼字體。可以全選需要安裝的字體,然后按Ctrl+C組合鍵進(jìn)行復(fù)制操作,再按照相應(yīng)的路徑(C:iWindowsl)找到“Fonts”文件夾,打開該文件夾,按Ctrl+V組合鍵,將復(fù)制的字體進(jìn)行粘貼即可。 2、“安裝”字體。首先選擇需要安裝的字體,然后單擊鼠標(biāo)右鍵,從彈出的快捷菜單中選擇“安裝”命令即可安裝。此外,還可以雙擊要安裝的字體文件,在打開的字體對(duì)話框中單擊“安裝”按鈕即可。 3、使用快捷方式安裝字體。在需要安裝大批量的字體時(shí),為了防止占用系統(tǒng)磁盤空間,影響軟件的運(yùn)行速度,可以使用快捷方式來(lái)安裝字體,具體操作方法如下: 步驟1:根據(jù)路徑(C:iWindowslFonts)打開“Fonts”文件夾,單擊左側(cè)的“字體設(shè)置”選項(xiàng)按鈕。 步驟2:在打開的“字體設(shè)置”界面中,勾選“允許使用快捷方式安裝字體(高級(jí))”復(fù)選框,單擊“確定”按鈕,關(guān)閉該界面。 步驟3:打開要安裝的字體文件夾,全選字體,單擊鼠標(biāo)右鍵,從彈出的快捷菜單中選擇“作為快捷方式安裝”選項(xiàng)即可。 根據(jù)內(nèi)容輸入文本 制作演示文稿時(shí)需要在其中輸入文本,然后設(shè)置文本的字體、字號(hào)、字符間距、文本的特殊效果等操作。 一、輸入文本。想要在幻燈片中輸入文本,則需要占位符和文本框做載體。介紹兩種常見(jiàn)的文本輸入方法: 1、在占位符中輸入文本。幻燈片中的占位符由幻燈片的版式?jīng)Q定,用戶可以直接在占位符中輸入文本,具體的操作步驟如下: 步驟1:打開演示文稿,將光標(biāo)定位至需要輸入文本的占位符中。 步驟2:選擇合適的輸入法,直接在占位符中輸入文本即可。 2、在文本框中輸入文本。需要在幻燈片中添加文本框,然后才能輸入文本,具體操作方法如下: 步驟1:切換至“插入”選項(xiàng)卡,在“文本”選項(xiàng)組中單擊“文本框”下拉按鈕,在展開的列表中選擇“繪制橫排文本框”選項(xiàng)。 步驟2:鼠標(biāo)光標(biāo)變?yōu)槭中螤睿醋∈髽?biāo)左鍵不放,在頁(yè)面合適位置拖動(dòng)鼠標(biāo)繪制文本框。 步驟3:繪制好后松開鼠標(biāo),此時(shí)幻燈片中出現(xiàn)一個(gè)虛線框,即為文本框,并且光標(biāo)自動(dòng)定位至文本框中。 步驟4:在文本框中直接輸入文字即可。 二、調(diào)整字體字號(hào) 在幻燈片中輸入文本后,可以對(duì)文本的字體、字號(hào)進(jìn)行設(shè)置,具體的操作方法如下: 步驟1:調(diào)整字體。選擇需要調(diào)整字體的文本框,然后在“開始”選項(xiàng)卡中單擊“字體”下拉按鈕。 步驟2:從展開的下拉列表中選擇“漢儀行楷簡(jiǎn)”選項(xiàng)。 步驟3:按照同樣的方法設(shè)置其他文本的字體,查看設(shè)置的效果。 步驟4:調(diào)整字號(hào)。選擇需要調(diào)整字號(hào)的文本框,在“字號(hào)”文本框中輸入“80”。 步驟5:按Enter鍵確認(rèn)輸入。按照同樣的方法設(shè)置其他文本的字號(hào)。 提示:可以選擇需要設(shè)置顏色的文本,在“開始”選項(xiàng)卡中單擊“字體顏色”下拉按鈕,從列表中選擇合適的顏色,即可為所選文本設(shè)置顏色。 三、應(yīng)用文本特殊效果 如果用戶想要文本特殊顯示,可以為其設(shè)置加粗、傾斜、陰影、下劃線等效果,下面將介紹具體的操作方法: 步驟1:加粗。選擇需要加粗的文本,在“開臺(tái)”選項(xiàng)卡中單擊“加粗”按鈕即可使文本加粗顯示。 步驟2:傾斜。選擇文本,在“開始”選項(xiàng)卡中單擊“傾斜”按鈕,即可將文本變傾斜。 步驟3:陰影。選擇文本,在“開始”選項(xiàng)卡中單擊“文字陰影”按鈕。 步驟4:下劃線。選擇文本,在“開始”選項(xiàng)卡中單擊“下劃線”按鈕。 步驟5:如果用戶想要清除設(shè)置的效果,則可以單擊“清除所有格式”按鈕,可以將所設(shè)置的格式效果清除。 編輯輸入的文本 在幻燈片中輸入文本后,通常還需要對(duì)其進(jìn)行各種編輯,這時(shí)就會(huì)涉及到對(duì)文本的一些基礎(chǔ)操作,例如選取文本、移動(dòng)與復(fù)制文本、查找和替換等。 一、選取文本 1、選擇連續(xù)的文本。只需要將光標(biāo)定位至需要選擇文本的開始位置,然后按住鼠標(biāo)左鍵不放,拖動(dòng)鼠標(biāo)至需要選擇文本的結(jié)束位置,釋放鼠標(biāo)左鍵即可。此外,用戶也可以將光標(biāo)定位至需要選擇文本的開始位置,然后按住Shift鍵不放,單擊選擇文本的結(jié)束處,即可將開始到結(jié)束處的這段文本內(nèi)容全部選中。 2、選擇單個(gè)詞語(yǔ)。需要將光標(biāo)定位至某個(gè)詞語(yǔ)的任意位置,然后雙擊鼠標(biāo),即可將該詞語(yǔ)選中。還可以將光標(biāo)定位至詞語(yǔ)的開始位置,然后按住鼠標(biāo)左鍵不放,拖動(dòng)鼠標(biāo)至詞語(yǔ)的結(jié)束位置,釋放鼠標(biāo)左鍵,即可將該詞語(yǔ)選中。 3、選擇段落。在選擇段落的任意位置處連續(xù)單擊3次鼠標(biāo)左鍵,即可將該段落選中。 4、選擇多處不連續(xù)的區(qū)域。在文檔中先使用拖動(dòng)鼠標(biāo)的方法選擇一個(gè)文本,然后按住Ctrl鍵不放,依次選擇其他文本,這樣就可以將多個(gè)不連續(xù)的區(qū)域選中。 5、選擇全部文本。使用快捷鍵全選文本,只需將光標(biāo)定位至文本中任意位置,然后按Ctrl+A組合鍵,即可將文本全部選中。 二、移動(dòng)和復(fù)制文本 用戶使用移動(dòng)與復(fù)制命令,可以減少重復(fù)文本的錄入,提高工作效率。 1、移動(dòng)文本。可以使用“剪切”命令移動(dòng)文本,操作如下: 步驟1:選中需要移動(dòng)的文本,在“開始”選項(xiàng)卡中單擊“剪切”按鈕。 步驟2:選擇需要粘貼文本的幻燈片,然后在“開始”選項(xiàng)卡中單擊“粘貼”按鈕,文本隨即被移動(dòng)到該幻燈片中。 步驟3:選中文本,然后按住鼠標(biāo)左鍵不放,拖動(dòng)鼠標(biāo),即可將其移至幻燈片頁(yè)面合適位置。 提示:使用快捷鍵Ctrl+X剪切文本,然后使用Ctrl+V粘貼文本,也可以移動(dòng)文本。 2、復(fù)制文本。復(fù)制文本是將所選內(nèi)容復(fù)制到剪貼板,然后粘貼到其他位置,具體操作方法如下: 步驟1:選擇需要復(fù)制的文本,然后在“開始”選項(xiàng)卡中單擊“復(fù)制”按鈕。 步驟2:選擇需要粘貼的幻燈片,單擊“粘貼”按鈕,即可復(fù)制選擇的文本。 提示:用戶也可以選擇需要復(fù)制的文本,按Ctrl+D組合鍵進(jìn)行復(fù)制。 三、查找與替換文本 當(dāng)演示文稿中出現(xiàn)大量的錯(cuò)誤文本時(shí),為了節(jié)省時(shí)間,可以使用查找和替換功能進(jìn)行更改,下面將介紹具體的操作方法: 1、查找文本。首先要將錯(cuò)誤的文本查找出來(lái),具體操作方法如下: 步驟1:打開演示文稿,在“開始”選項(xiàng)卡中單擊“編輯”選項(xiàng)組的“查找”按鈕。 步驟2:打開“查找”對(duì)話框,在“查找內(nèi)容”文本框中輸入要查找的文本,這里輸入“想要查找的文本內(nèi)容”,然后單擊“查找下一個(gè)”按鈕。 步驟3:此時(shí),查找到的文本處于選中狀態(tài),用戶可以確認(rèn)是否屬于錄入錯(cuò)誤。 步驟4:繼續(xù)單擊“查找下一個(gè)”按鈕,當(dāng)查找到最后一個(gè)文本時(shí),會(huì)彈出提示對(duì)話框,提示用戶已經(jīng)查找到最后一個(gè)匹配項(xiàng)目,單擊“確定”按鈕,關(guān)閉“查找”對(duì)話框即可。 2、替換文本。用戶可以逐一替換錯(cuò)誤的文本,也可以全部替換,具體的操作方法如下: 步驟1:在“開始”選項(xiàng)卡中單擊“編輯”選項(xiàng)組的“替換”按鈕。 步驟2:打開“替換”對(duì)話框,在“查找內(nèi)容”文本框中輸入要查找的文本,然后在“替換為”文本框中輸入要替換的文本,單擊“查找下一個(gè)”按鈕。 步驟3:系統(tǒng)隨即查找到相匹配的文本,接著單擊“替換”按鈕,即可將文本進(jìn)行替換。 步驟4:如果單擊“全部替換”按鈕,可以一次性將查找到的文本全部替換。 設(shè)置文本段落 在幻燈片中輸入文本內(nèi)容后需要對(duì)其設(shè)置段落格式,這樣整個(gè)頁(yè)面才能更加美觀,段落格式的設(shè)置包括設(shè)置段落對(duì)齊方式、行及段落間距等。 一、設(shè)置段落對(duì)齊方式 段落對(duì)齊方式是指段落對(duì)齊到文本框的方式,包括水平對(duì)齊和垂直對(duì)齊。下面將介紹如何設(shè)置段落的水平對(duì)齊方式。 步驟1:選中需要設(shè)置對(duì)齊方式的文本,在“開始”選項(xiàng)卡中單擊“居中”按鈕。 步驟2:此外,用戶還可以在“開始”選項(xiàng)卡中單擊“對(duì)齊文本”下拉按鈕,從列表中選擇所需的垂直對(duì)齊方式。 二、設(shè)置行間距及段落間距 如果一個(gè)文本框中包含多個(gè)行和段落,為其置合適的行和段落間距,可以使整個(gè)幻燈片頁(yè)看起來(lái)更加舒適、美觀,下面將介紹如何設(shè)置子及段落間距。 1、設(shè)置行距。行距是指每一行文字之間的距離,設(shè)置行距的操作方法如下: 步驟1:選中要設(shè)置行距的文本,在“開始”選頁(yè)卡中單擊“行距”下拉按鈕。 步驟2:對(duì)選中的文本各行之間的間距進(jìn)行相應(yīng)的調(diào)整。 2、設(shè)置段落間距。段落間距是指段落與段落之間的距離,可以設(shè)置段前和段后的距離,具體操作方法如下: 步驟1:選擇需要設(shè)置段落間距的文本,在“開始”選項(xiàng)卡中單擊“段落”選項(xiàng)組的對(duì)話框啟動(dòng)器按鈕。 步驟2:打開“段落”對(duì)話框,在“縮進(jìn)和間距”選項(xiàng)卡中設(shè)置“段前”、“段后”間距,設(shè)置完成后單擊“確定”按鈕。 三、添加項(xiàng)目符號(hào)及編號(hào) 為文本添加項(xiàng)目符號(hào)或編號(hào)可使文本內(nèi)容更有條理性,下面講解如何添加項(xiàng)目符號(hào)及編號(hào)。 步驟1:添加項(xiàng)目符號(hào)。選中需要添加項(xiàng)目符號(hào)的文本,在“開始”選項(xiàng)卡中單擊“項(xiàng)目符號(hào)”下拉按鈕,從列表中選擇合適的項(xiàng)目符號(hào),這里選擇“帶填充效果的鉆石形項(xiàng)目符號(hào)”選項(xiàng)。 步驟2:可以看到選中的文本隨即被添加了項(xiàng)目符號(hào)。 四、設(shè)置文本分欄 步驟1:選擇需要分欄的文本,在“開始”選項(xiàng)卡中單擊“添加或刪除欄”下拉按鈕。 步驟2:從展開的列表中選擇“更多欄”選項(xiàng)。 步驟3:打開“欄”對(duì)話框,在“數(shù)量”微調(diào)框中輸入數(shù)值“3”,在“間距”微調(diào)框中輸入數(shù)值“0.5”,設(shè)置完成后單擊“確定”按鈕。 步驟4:文本隨即被分成3欄,并按照設(shè)置調(diào)整了各欄之間的間距。 藝術(shù)字的妙用 在制作幻燈片時(shí)使用藝術(shù)字可以快速抓住觀眾的眼球,而且外觀多變的藝術(shù)字還能為幻燈片增加活潑生動(dòng)的氣息。 步驟1:打開演示文稿,切換至“插入”選項(xiàng)卡,單擊“文本”選項(xiàng)組中的“藝術(shù)字”下拉按鈕,從列表中選擇合適的藝術(shù)字效果。 步驟2:幻燈片中隨即插入一個(gè)相應(yīng)的藝術(shù)字文本框,接著在文本框中直接輸入內(nèi)容即可。 美化文本 除了利用藝術(shù)字功能來(lái)美化文本外,還可以利用文本自帶的美化功能,例如設(shè)置三維旋轉(zhuǎn)文本、設(shè)置路徑文本等,制作出不一樣的文字效果。 一、設(shè)置三維旋轉(zhuǎn)文本。在PPT中利用“三維旋轉(zhuǎn)”功能可以制作透視字體效果,具體操作方法如下: 步驟1:選擇幻燈片,切換至“插入”選項(xiàng)卡,擊“文本”選項(xiàng)組的“文本框”下拉按鈕,從表中選擇“豎排文本框”選項(xiàng)。繪制一個(gè)豎排文本框,并在其中輸入文本內(nèi)容。 步驟2:選中文本。在“開始”選項(xiàng)卡中將“字體”設(shè)置為“方正隸書簡(jiǎn)體”,將“字號(hào)”設(shè)置為“96”,將“字體顏色”設(shè)置為“白色”。 步驟3:選中文本框,單擊鼠標(biāo)右鍵,從彈出的快捷菜單中選擇“設(shè)置形狀格式”命令。 步驟4:打開“設(shè)置形狀格式”窗格,切換至“效果”選項(xiàng)卡。在“三維旋轉(zhuǎn)”選項(xiàng)組中設(shè)置“X旋轉(zhuǎn)”“Y旋轉(zhuǎn)”和“Z旋轉(zhuǎn)”。 步驟5:設(shè)置完成后關(guān)閉窗格。選中文本框,切換至“繪圖工具-格式”選項(xiàng)卡,單擊“藝術(shù)字樣式”選項(xiàng)組的對(duì)話框啟動(dòng)器按鈕。 步驟6:打開“設(shè)置形狀格式”窗格,切換至“文本填充與輪廓”選項(xiàng)卡,在“文本填充”選項(xiàng)組中調(diào)整“透明度”。 步驟7:調(diào)整好后關(guān)閉窗格,然后復(fù)制該文本框,并修改文本框的文字內(nèi)容,同時(shí)調(diào)整該文本的字號(hào)。 步驟8:選中復(fù)制的文本框,打開“設(shè)置形狀格式”窗格。在“效果”選項(xiàng)卡中設(shè)置“三維旋轉(zhuǎn)”的“X旋轉(zhuǎn)”“Y旋轉(zhuǎn)”和“Z旋轉(zhuǎn)”。 步驟9:設(shè)置完成后關(guān)閉窗格,查看制作透視字體的效果。 提示:由于透視角度的不同,所以文字位置一旦變化.就需要重新調(diào)整參數(shù)。 二、設(shè)置路徑文本 用戶可以通過(guò)“文字效果”功能來(lái)制作拱形字體,具體操作方法如下: 步驟1:繪制橫排文本框并輸入文本。 步驟2:選擇文本,在“開始”選項(xiàng)卡中將“字體”設(shè)置為“漢儀橄欖體簡(jiǎn)”,將“字號(hào)”設(shè)置為“44”,將“字體顏色”設(shè)置為“深綠色”。 步驟3:切換至“繪圖工具-格式”選項(xiàng)卡,單擊“文字效果”下拉按鈕。 步驟4:從展開的列表中選擇“轉(zhuǎn)換”選項(xiàng),并從其級(jí)聯(lián)菜單中選擇“拱形”效果。 步驟5:文字已變形。為了能夠與圖中地球輪廓相一致,則需對(duì)它進(jìn)行調(diào)整。 步驟6:選中文字,將其移至合適的位置后,將光標(biāo)放在文本框下方的中點(diǎn)上,此時(shí)光標(biāo)變?yōu)殡p向箭頭。 步驟7:按住鼠標(biāo)左鍵不放,向下拖動(dòng)鼠標(biāo)至合適位置,調(diào)整文字的彎曲度。 步驟8:調(diào)整文字的方向,將光標(biāo)移動(dòng)至文字起始處的路徑圓點(diǎn)(橙色的圓點(diǎn))位置,按住鼠標(biāo)左鍵不放,拖動(dòng)該控制點(diǎn)至合適位置,可調(diào)整文字路徑。 步驟9:對(duì)路徑進(jìn)行反復(fù)調(diào)整后,查看效果。 步驟10:改變“心”和“家”文字的“字號(hào)”和“顏色”。查看制作拱形文字的效果。 提示:將路徑圓點(diǎn)向下拖動(dòng)時(shí),文字會(huì)隨著路徑適當(dāng)放大;相反,將路徑圓點(diǎn)向上拖動(dòng)時(shí),文字會(huì)隨之縮小。 圖片制作攻略 PPT中如果只有文字,則會(huì)顯得枯燥乏味。而使用圖文結(jié)合的模式更能吸引觀眾的注意力,所以圖片在幻燈片中起著重要的作用。選擇一張好的圖片,會(huì)使PPT更加出彩。本章將對(duì)圖片的選擇、插入和編輯操作進(jìn)行全面介紹。 圖片選擇方法 在制作幻燈片時(shí),用戶通常不清楚使用什么樣的圖片比較合適,其實(shí)圖片的選擇也有技巧。選擇合適的圖片不僅能在內(nèi)容上契合主題,也會(huì)使頁(yè)面更美觀。下面就介紹在選擇圖片時(shí)需要注意的幾點(diǎn)問(wèn)題: 一、選擇高清的圖片 高清的圖片能給人視覺(jué)上的享受,如果圖片模糊不清,不僅看起來(lái)很粗糙,而且容易使觀眾產(chǎn)生視覺(jué)疲勞。 二、選擇與內(nèi)容相關(guān)的圖片 在制作PPT時(shí),要選擇和幻燈片中內(nèi)容相關(guān)的圖片,或與主題相關(guān)的圖片,這樣便于觀眾的理解。 三、選擇與PPT風(fēng)格相關(guān)的圖片 除了注意以上兩點(diǎn)以外,用戶還要注意選擇的圖片是否符合當(dāng)前PPT的風(fēng)格。PPT可分為以下4種風(fēng)格。 1、嚴(yán)肅沉穩(wěn)。此類風(fēng)格的PPT,大多以寫實(shí)圖片為主,并且細(xì)節(jié)豐富,光影變化細(xì)膩,給人一種沉穩(wěn)、可信感。 2、輕松幽默。此類風(fēng)格的PPT,主要以搞怪的表情或動(dòng)作圖片為主,這樣可以增加幻燈片的趣味性。 3、詩(shī)情畫意。此類型的PPT沒(méi)有明確的主題,主要以浪漫、清新或懷舊類圖片為主,以渲染主題氣氛。 4、另類獨(dú)特。此類PPT一般都以創(chuàng)意性很強(qiáng)的圖片或者以繪制的圖案為主,也可以兩者結(jié)合,給人獨(dú)樹一幟的感覺(jué)。 好圖片的搜索方法 有人說(shuō)使用“百度”搜索到的圖片其質(zhì)量參差不齊,不好挑選。其實(shí)不然,有這種想法的人是因?yàn)樗麄儧](méi)有找對(duì)方法。下面就向用戶推薦幾種搜索圖片的方法。 一、提煉搜索關(guān)鍵字。輸入關(guān)鍵字即可。例如搜索“時(shí)間飛逝”類的圖片,輸入“時(shí)間”關(guān)鍵字。而如果輸入“時(shí)間匆匆”關(guān)鍵字后,搜索的結(jié)果就大相徑庭。 二、組合詞搜索法。有時(shí)候單憑一個(gè)關(guān)鍵詞搜索出來(lái)的圖片范圍太廣,想要從中找到符合的圖片很費(fèi)勁,這時(shí)可以試著將幾個(gè)關(guān)鍵詞組合在一起進(jìn)行搜索,限制搜索條件,這樣搜索出來(lái)的圖片會(huì)更精準(zhǔn)一些。 三、聯(lián)想詞搜索法。有時(shí)使用關(guān)鍵詞和組合詞都搜索不出滿意的圖片,尤其是搜索一些偏理念或概念化的內(nèi)容,很難找到對(duì)應(yīng)的圖片,這時(shí)可以嘗試聯(lián)想詞搜索。將抽象的概念具體化,這需要用戶發(fā)散思維來(lái)聯(lián)想。例如,想要尋找關(guān)于“探索”的圖片,則可以用“宇宙”關(guān)鍵字進(jìn)行搜索。用戶也可以搜索“望遠(yuǎn)”,對(duì)遠(yuǎn)方的未知,也能激發(fā)人們?nèi)ヌ剿鳌?/p> 提示:圖片也有版權(quán),如果將圖片用于商業(yè)用途,則需要支付版權(quán)費(fèi),使用時(shí)需要謹(jǐn)慎。 在文中插入圖片 一、插入本機(jī)圖片 在制作幻燈片前,通常會(huì)先搜集相關(guān)圖片,將滿意的圖片保存在電腦中,然后在制作時(shí)將這些圖片插入到幻燈片中。 步驟1:打開演示文稿,切換至“插入”選項(xiàng)卡,單擊“圖像”選項(xiàng)組中的“圖片”按鈕。 步驟2:打開“插入圖片”對(duì)話框,在“桌面”找到保存的圖片,然后單擊“插入”按鈕。 步驟3:選中的圖片隨即被插入到幻燈片中。 步驟4:將光標(biāo)移至圖片右下角的控制點(diǎn)上,按住鼠標(biāo)左鍵不放,拖動(dòng)鼠標(biāo)調(diào)整圖片的大小。 步驟5:將光標(biāo)置于圖片上方,按住鼠標(biāo)左鍵不放,拖動(dòng)鼠標(biāo)將其移至頁(yè)面合適位置。 二、插入屏幕截圖 用戶可以使用屏幕截圖功能,將在桌面上打開的網(wǎng)頁(yè)或其他內(nèi)容捕捉下來(lái)的圖片插入到幻燈片中,下面介紹具體的操作方法。 步驟1:選擇幻燈片,在“插入”選項(xiàng)卡中單擊“圖像”選項(xiàng)組中的“屏幕截圖”下拉按鈕,從列表中選擇“屏幕剪輯”選項(xiàng)。 步驟2:屏幕隨即變?yōu)槟:隣顟B(tài),按住鼠標(biāo)左鍵不放,在打開的網(wǎng)頁(yè)上拖動(dòng)鼠標(biāo),截取所需的部分圖像,此時(shí)被選取的區(qū)域會(huì)變得清晰。 步驟3:選取完成后松開鼠標(biāo),此時(shí)選取的部分圖像就被插入到了幻燈片中,最后調(diào)整圖片的大小和位置即可。 修飾圖片 在圖片插入到幻燈片后,用戶還可以對(duì)其進(jìn)行各種設(shè)置,例如更改圖片的顏色、樣式、外觀,或裁剪圖片等,使圖片更加契合幻燈片頁(yè)面。下面將分別對(duì)其進(jìn)行詳細(xì)介紹。 一、更改圖片的顏色 如果用戶對(duì)圖片的顏色不滿意,可以對(duì)其進(jìn)行更改。 步驟1:選擇圖片,切換至“圖片工具-格式”選項(xiàng)卡,單擊“顏色”下拉按鈕。 步驟2:在展開列表的“色調(diào)”區(qū)域,選擇“色溫:8800K”選項(xiàng),可以看到選中的圖片已經(jīng)被修改為相應(yīng)的顏色。 二、更改圖片的亮度/對(duì)比度 用戶可以根據(jù)需要調(diào)整圖片的亮度與對(duì)比度。下面以將圖片更改為“亮度:+40%對(duì)比度:-40%”為例,介紹具體的操作方法。 步驟1:選中圖片,在“圖片工具-格式”選項(xiàng)卡中單擊“校正”下拉按鈕。 步驟2:從展開的列表中選擇“亮度:+40%對(duì)比度:-40%”選項(xiàng),選中圖片的亮度和對(duì)比度隨即進(jìn)行相應(yīng)的調(diào)整。 三、設(shè)置圖片的藝術(shù)效果 用戶可以為圖片添加藝術(shù)效果,使圖片更具有藝術(shù)氣息。下面以為圖片添加“紋理化”藝術(shù)效果為例,介紹具體的操作方法。 步驟1:選中圖片,在“圖片工具-格式”選項(xiàng)卡中單擊“藝術(shù)效果”下拉按鈕。 步驟2:從展開的列表中選擇“蠟筆平滑”選項(xiàng),選中的圖片隨即應(yīng)用了該藝術(shù)效果。 提示:用戶可以在“藝術(shù)效果”下拉列表中選擇“藝術(shù)效果選項(xiàng)”選項(xiàng),打開“設(shè)置圖片格式”窗格,在“藝術(shù)效果”選項(xiàng)組中可以設(shè)置“透明度”和“縮放”選項(xiàng)來(lái)調(diào)整運(yùn)用的藝術(shù)效果。 四、設(shè)置圖片樣式 PPT內(nèi)置了很多圖片樣式,用戶可以根據(jù)需要設(shè)置相應(yīng)的圖片樣式。下面以將圖片的樣式設(shè)置為“簡(jiǎn)單框架,白色”為例,介紹具體的操作方法。 步驟1:選擇圖片,在“圖片工具-格式”選項(xiàng)卡中單擊“快速樣式”按鈕。 步驟2:從展開的列表中選擇“簡(jiǎn)單框架,白色”選項(xiàng),選中的圖片隨即應(yīng)用該樣式。 五、對(duì)圖片進(jìn)行裁剪 當(dāng)幻燈片中的圖片尺寸過(guò)大時(shí),為了不影響整體美觀,用戶可以對(duì)其進(jìn)行裁剪。下面以將圖片裁剪成“心形”為例,向用戶介紹圖片的裁剪操作。 步驟1:選中需要裁剪的圖片,在“圖片工具-格式”選項(xiàng)卡中單擊“裁剪”下拉按鈕。 步驟2:從展開的列表中選擇“裁剪為形狀”選項(xiàng),并從其級(jí)聯(lián)菜單中選擇合適的形狀,這里選擇“心形”選項(xiàng)。選中的圖片隨即被裁剪成心形。 六、刪除圖片背景 PPT還具有一些簡(jiǎn)單的圖片處理功能,例如“摳圖”功能,即將圖片的背景刪除,下面介紹具體的操作方法。 步驟1:選中圖片,切換至“圖片工具-格式”選項(xiàng)卡,在“調(diào)整”選項(xiàng)組中單擊“刪除背景”按鈕。 步驟2:功能區(qū)左側(cè)新增一個(gè)“背景消除”選項(xiàng)卡,圖片周圍出現(xiàn)8個(gè)控制點(diǎn),并且背景變?yōu)樽仙?/p> 步驟3:將光標(biāo)移到下方中間的控制點(diǎn)上,按住鼠標(biāo)左鍵向下拖動(dòng)鼠標(biāo),調(diào)整保留的區(qū)域。 步驟4:若調(diào)整控制點(diǎn)后仍有一部分不在保留區(qū)域,則可以單擊“標(biāo)記要保留的區(qū)域”按鈕。 步驟5:鼠標(biāo)光標(biāo)變?yōu)楣P樣式,然后單擊鼠標(biāo)標(biāo)記要保留的區(qū)域。 步驟6:標(biāo)記完成后,單擊“保留更改”按鈕。可以看到圖片的背景已經(jīng)被刪除,只保留了主體部分。 提示:若用戶需要?jiǎng)h除多余的標(biāo)記,則可以單擊“刪除標(biāo)記”按鈕,此時(shí)該按鈕處于選中狀態(tài),然后在多余的標(biāo)記上單擊鼠標(biāo)左鍵,即可將其刪除,刪除完成后再次單擊“刪除標(biāo)記”按鈕退出即可。 表格與圖表 用戶在制作分析類演示文稿時(shí),可以使用表格來(lái)對(duì)數(shù)據(jù)進(jìn)行分析和管理,在幻燈片中插入表格的方法有多種,如插入固定行和列的表格、插入指定表格、插入Excel表格等,本節(jié)將對(duì)其進(jìn)行詳細(xì)介紹。 在PPT中插入表格 一、插入固定行數(shù)、列數(shù)的表格 在“表格”列表中滑動(dòng)鼠標(biāo),可以直接插入表格,但最多只能創(chuàng)建8行10列之內(nèi)的表格。 步驟1:選擇幻燈片,切換至“插入”選項(xiàng)卡,單擊“表格”下拉按鈕,在展開的列表中滑動(dòng)鼠標(biāo),選取8行10列的表格。 步驟2:選取完成后單擊鼠標(biāo),即可插入。 步驟3:調(diào)整表格的大小和位置,然后在其中輸入數(shù)據(jù)即可。 二、插入指定的表格 如果第一種方法滿足不了需求,還可以通過(guò)對(duì)話框插入表格,具體操作方法如下: 步驟1:選擇幻燈片,切換至“插入”選項(xiàng)卡,單擊“表格”下拉按鈕,從列表中選擇“插入表格”選項(xiàng)。 步驟2:打開“插入表格”對(duì)話框,輸入“列數(shù)”和“行數(shù)”數(shù)值,單擊“確定”按鈕。幻燈片中隨即插入一個(gè)5列10行的表格。 步驟3:調(diào)整表格的大小和位置,輸入數(shù)據(jù)內(nèi)容即可。 對(duì)表格進(jìn)行編輯 在插入表格后,用戶可以根據(jù)需要對(duì)表格進(jìn)行編輯,例如設(shè)置文本對(duì)齊方式、調(diào)整行高和列寬、拆分或合并單元格等,下面將分別對(duì)其進(jìn)行詳細(xì)介紹。 一、設(shè)置文本對(duì)齊方式 步驟1:選中表格,切換至“表格工具-布局”選項(xiàng)卡,在“對(duì)齊方式”選項(xiàng)組中單擊“居中”按鈕。可以看到表格中的文本內(nèi)容已經(jīng)水平居中顯示。 步驟2:在“對(duì)齊方式”選項(xiàng)組中單擊“垂直居中”按鈕。可以看到表格中的文本內(nèi)容已經(jīng)垂直居中顯示。 提示:用戶也可以在“開始”選項(xiàng)卡中單擊“段落”選項(xiàng)組中的“居中”按鈕,將文本設(shè)置為水平居中。單擊“對(duì)齊文本”下拉按鈕,從列表中選擇“中部對(duì)齊”選項(xiàng),可以將文本設(shè)置為垂直居中顯示。 二、調(diào)整行高和列寬 在表格中輸入數(shù)據(jù)后,因?yàn)閿?shù)據(jù)類型的差異,所以需要調(diào)整某行或某列的高度和寬度,使表格看起來(lái)更美觀、協(xié)調(diào)。下面將介紹表格行高和列寬的調(diào)整操作: 步驟1:調(diào)整列寬。將光標(biāo)移至需要調(diào)整列寬的列右側(cè)邊線上,光標(biāo)變?yōu)殡p箭頭形狀。 步驟2:按住鼠標(biāo)左鍵不放,拖動(dòng)鼠標(biāo),光標(biāo)下方出現(xiàn)一條虛線。 步驟3:拖動(dòng)鼠標(biāo)將虛線移到合適位置后松開,可以調(diào)整列寬。按照同樣的方法,調(diào)整其他列的寬度。 三、拆分或合并單元格 為了使表格中的數(shù)據(jù)能夠合理分布,用戶需要對(duì)單元格進(jìn)行合并或拆分,下面介紹具體的操作方法: 步驟1:合并單元格。選中需要合并的單元格區(qū)域,切換至“表格工具-布局”選項(xiàng)卡,單擊“合并單元格”按鈕。選中的單元格區(qū)域隨即被合并成一個(gè)單元格。按照同樣的方法,合并其他單元格區(qū)域。 步驟3:拆分單元格。選中需要拆分的單元格,在“布局”選項(xiàng)卡中單擊“拆分單元格”按鈕。打開“拆分單元格”對(duì)話框,在“列數(shù)”和“行數(shù)”微調(diào)框中輸入數(shù)值,單擊“確定”按鈕。 對(duì)表格進(jìn)行美化 在幻燈片中創(chuàng)建的表格是自帶表格樣式的。如果想要更改表格樣式,使其看起來(lái)更加美觀,則可以使用內(nèi)置樣式美化表格,或自定義表格樣式。 一、使用表格內(nèi)置樣式 步驟1:選中表格,切換至“表格工具-設(shè)計(jì)”選項(xiàng)卡,單擊“表格樣式”選項(xiàng)組中的“其他”按鈕。 步驟2:從展開的列表中選擇合適的表格樣式,可以選擇“中度樣式3-強(qiáng)調(diào)6”選項(xiàng),可以看到表格應(yīng)用了所選的樣式。 提示:如果用戶想要清除應(yīng)用的表格樣式,則可以在“表格樣式”下拉列表中選擇“清除表格”選項(xiàng)即可。 二、自定義表格樣式 如果內(nèi)置的表格樣式無(wú)法滿足需求,則可以自定義表格樣式。例如,設(shè)置表格的邊框、底紋等,下面對(duì)其進(jìn)行詳細(xì)介紹。 步驟1:選中表格,在“表格工具-設(shè)計(jì)”選項(xiàng)卡中單擊“繪制邊框”選項(xiàng)組中的“筆劃粗細(xì)”下拉按鈕。 步驟2:從展開的列表中選擇“3.0磅”選項(xiàng)。 步驟3:在“繪制邊框”選項(xiàng)組中單擊“筆顏色”下拉按鈕,從列表中選擇合適的顏色。 提示:在幻燈片中,用戶還可以使用圖表來(lái)展示數(shù)據(jù),它使復(fù)雜的數(shù)據(jù)關(guān)系變得可視化、形象化,并且增強(qiáng)了幻燈片的感染力。 圖表另類畫法 如果用戶覺(jué)得創(chuàng)建的圖表千篇一律,不能引起觀眾的興趣,則可以在基礎(chǔ)圖表上增加一點(diǎn)創(chuàng)意,這樣圖表就能變得妙趣橫生,讓人眼前一亮。 用戶可以使用圖片填充功能,制作出創(chuàng)意條形圖,下面介紹具體的操作步驟: 步驟1:在“插入”選項(xiàng)卡中單擊“圖表”按鈕,打開“插入圖表”對(duì)話框,選擇“條形圖”選項(xiàng),并在右側(cè)選擇“簇狀條形圖”類型,單擊“確定”按鈕。 步驟2:在打開的Excel電子表格中輸入相關(guān)數(shù)據(jù),單擊“關(guān)閉”按鈕。 步驟3:幻燈片中隨即創(chuàng)建一個(gè)簇狀條形圖。選中條形圖,在“設(shè)計(jì)”選項(xiàng)卡中單擊“添加圖表元素”下拉按鈕,從列表中選擇“坐標(biāo)軸→主要橫坐標(biāo)軸”選項(xiàng),隱藏橫坐標(biāo)軸。 步驟4:在“添加圖表元素”下拉列表中選擇“網(wǎng)格線→主軸主要垂直網(wǎng)格線”選項(xiàng),隱藏圖表的網(wǎng)格線。 步驟5:選中垂直坐標(biāo)軸,單擊鼠標(biāo)右鍵,從彈出的快捷菜單中選擇“設(shè)置坐標(biāo)軸格式”命令。 步驟6:彈出“設(shè)置坐標(biāo)軸格式”窗格,切換至“坐標(biāo)軸選項(xiàng)”選項(xiàng)卡,在“刻度線”選項(xiàng)組中單擊“主刻度線類型”右側(cè)的下拉按鈕,從列表中選擇“無(wú)”選項(xiàng)。 步驟7:關(guān)閉窗格,查看設(shè)置的效果。 步驟8:選中“步行”系列數(shù)據(jù)點(diǎn),單擊鼠標(biāo)右鍵,從彈出的快捷菜單中選擇“設(shè)置數(shù)據(jù)點(diǎn)格式”命令。 步驟9:打開“設(shè)置數(shù)據(jù)點(diǎn)格式”窗格,切換至“填充與線條”選項(xiàng)卡,在“填充”組中選中“圖片或紋理填充”單選按鈕,然后單擊下方的“文件”按鈕。 步驟10:打開“插入圖片”對(duì)話框,選擇合適的圖片,然后單擊“插入”按鈕。 步驟11:此時(shí),可以看到圖片被填充到被選中的柱形中,但該圖片已嚴(yán)重變形。 步驟12:再次打開“設(shè)置數(shù)據(jù)點(diǎn)格式”窗格,在“填充”選項(xiàng)組中選中“層疊”單選按鈕。 步驟13:此時(shí),可以看到填充的圖片恢復(fù)到原來(lái)的比例。 步驟14:按照同樣方法,填充其他系列數(shù)據(jù)點(diǎn),并刪除圖例,輸入圖表標(biāo)題,添加數(shù)據(jù)標(biāo)簽等。 步驟15:選中圖表,在“格式”選項(xiàng)卡中單擊“形狀樣式”選項(xiàng)組中的“形狀填充”下拉按鈕,從列表中選擇合適的填充顏色。 步驟16:查看設(shè)置好簇狀條形圖的最終效果。 添加音頻視頻 聲音的插入與調(diào)整 在制作演示文稿的過(guò)程中,特別是在制作商務(wù)方面的宣傳演示文稿時(shí),可以為幻燈片添加一些合適的聲音,添加的聲音可以配合圖文,使演示文稿變得有聲有色,更具感染力。 一、常見(jiàn)的音頻格式 PPT中常用WAV、MP3和MIDI等格式。 (1)WAV格式。WAV格式是Microsoft公司開發(fā)的一種聲音文件格式,用于保存Windows平臺(tái)的音頻信息資源,被Windows平臺(tái)及其應(yīng)用程序所支持,支持多種音頻位數(shù)、采樣頻率和聲道,是目前計(jì)算機(jī)上廣為流行的聲音文件格式,幾乎所有的音頻編輯軟件都識(shí)別WAV格式。 (2)MP3格式。MP3格式誕生于20世紀(jì)80年代的德國(guó),所謂的MP3是指MPEG標(biāo)準(zhǔn)中的音頻部分,也就是MPEG音頻層。MPEG音頻文件的壓縮是一種有損壓縮,犧牲了聲音文件中的12kHz~16kHz之間高音頻部分的質(zhì)量來(lái)壓縮文件的大小。相同時(shí)間的音樂(lè)文件,用MP3格式存儲(chǔ),一般只有WAV文件的1/10,而音質(zhì)要次于CD格式或WAV格式聲音文件。 (3)MIDI格式。MIDI即音樂(lè)設(shè)備數(shù)字接口(MusicalInstrumentDigitalInterface)的英文縮寫,是20世紀(jì)80年代初為解決電聲樂(lè)器之間的通信問(wèn)題而提出的。MIDI傳輸?shù)牟皇锹曇粜盘?hào),而是音符、控制參數(shù)等指令、MIDI文件本身并不包含波形數(shù)據(jù),所以MIDI文件非常小巧,非常適合作為網(wǎng)頁(yè)的背景音樂(lè)。 二、添加各類聲音 添加文件中的聲音就是將計(jì)算機(jī)中已存在的聲音插人到演示文稿中,也可以從其他的聲音文件中添加用戶需要的聲音。具體方法如下: (1)打開“XXX.pptx”,切換至“插入”面板,在“媒體”選項(xiàng)組中單擊“音頻”的下三角按鈕,在彈出的列表框中選擇“PC上的音頻”選項(xiàng)。 (2)彈出“插入音頻”對(duì)話框,選擇素材文件夾下的“bgmusicl.mp3”聲音文件,單擊“插入”按鈕。 (3)執(zhí)行操作后,可以拖曳聲音圖標(biāo)至合適位置,按〈F5〉鍵后幻燈片播放,單擊播放按鈕就可以聽(tīng)到插入的聲音。 (4)選擇音頻文件,執(zhí)行“音頻格式”→“播放”命令,打開“播放”面板,設(shè)置“開始”為“單擊時(shí)”,按〈F5〉鍵后幻燈片播放,音樂(lè)將自動(dòng)播放。 設(shè)置聲音屬性 打開PowerPoint,選擇需要插入的音頻文件,切換至“音頻格式”→“播放”面板,可設(shè)置音頻的相關(guān)播放屬性。 添加視頻 PowerPoint2013中的視頻包括視頻和動(dòng)畫,可以在幻燈片中插入的視頻格式有十幾種,PowerPoint支持的視頻格式會(huì)隨著媒體播放器的不同而不同,用戶可從剪輯管理器或從外部文件添加視頻。 一、常見(jiàn)的視頻格式 PPT中常插入的視頻格式包括AVI、WMV、MPEG、MOV及SWF等。 (1)AVI格式。AVI格式即音頻視頻交錯(cuò)格式(AudioVideoInterleaved)的英文縮寫,是Microsoft公司開發(fā)的一種視頻文件格式。所謂音頻視頻交錯(cuò),是指可以將視頻和音頻交織在一起進(jìn)行同步播放。這種視頻格式的優(yōu)點(diǎn)是圖像質(zhì)量好,可以跨平臺(tái)使用;缺點(diǎn)是體積過(guò)于龐大,而且壓縮標(biāo)準(zhǔn)不統(tǒng)一,時(shí)常會(huì)出現(xiàn)視頻編碼原因而造成視頻不能播放等問(wèn)題。用戶如果遇到了這些問(wèn)題,可以通過(guò)下載相應(yīng)的解碼器來(lái)解決。 (2)MOV格式。MOV即QuickTime影片格式,它是Apple公司開發(fā)的一種音頻、視頻文件格式,用于存儲(chǔ)常用數(shù)字媒體類型。 (3)MPEG格式。MPEG即運(yùn)動(dòng)圖像專家組格式(MovingPictureExpertGroup)的英文縮寫,日常生活中用戶欣賞的VCD、DVD就是這種格式,今天常用的有MP4格式。 (4)WMV格式。WMV即視窗媒體視頻(WindowsMediaVideo)的英文縮寫,是Microsoft公司推出的一種采用獨(dú)立編碼方式并且可以直接在網(wǎng)上實(shí)時(shí)觀看的視頻文件壓縮格式。 (5)SWF格式。SWF(ShockWaveFlash)是ADOBE公司的動(dòng)畫設(shè)計(jì)軟件Flash的專用格式,是一種支持矢量和點(diǎn)陣圖形的動(dòng)畫文件格式,被廣泛應(yīng)用于網(wǎng)頁(yè)設(shè)計(jì)、動(dòng)畫制作等領(lǐng)域,SWF文件通常也被稱為Flash文件。 二、添加文件中的視頻 添加文件中的視頻就是將計(jì)算機(jī)中已存在的視頻插人到演示文稿中。具體方法如下: (1)打開“視頻的使用.pptx”文件,切換至“插入”面板,在“媒體”選項(xiàng)組中單擊“視頻”的下三角按鈕,在彈出的列表框中選擇“PC上的視頻”選項(xiàng)。 (2)彈出“插入視頻”對(duì)話框,選擇素材文件夾下的“視頻樣例.wmv”聲音文件,單擊“插人”按鈕。 (3)執(zhí)行操作后,可以拖曳聲音圖標(biāo)至合適位置,按〈FS〉鍵后幻燈片播放,單擊播放按鈕即可播放視頻。 三、設(shè)置視頻屬性 在幻燈片中選中插入的視頻,切換至“播放”面板,其中“視頻選項(xiàng)”選項(xiàng)組中的各頁(yè)與“音頻”選項(xiàng)組中的各選項(xiàng)作用類似,用戶可根據(jù)需要設(shè)置各選項(xiàng)。 打開PowerPoint2013,選擇需要插入的視頻文件,切換至“視頻工具”→“格式”,可設(shè)置視頻的相關(guān)格式屬性。 動(dòng)畫設(shè)置方法 人類對(duì)運(yùn)動(dòng)與變化具有天生的敏感。不管這個(gè)運(yùn)動(dòng)有多么微不足道,變化多么微小,都會(huì)強(qiáng)烈地抓住人們的視線。PPT動(dòng)畫的根本在于因內(nèi)容而變化。對(duì)內(nèi)容的表現(xiàn)力越強(qiáng),動(dòng)畫效果就越成功。 動(dòng)畫的分類 在PowerPoint中,所謂動(dòng)畫效果主要分為進(jìn)入動(dòng)畫、強(qiáng)調(diào)動(dòng)畫、退出動(dòng)畫和動(dòng)作路徑動(dòng)畫四類,此外,還包括幻燈片切換動(dòng)畫,從而實(shí)現(xiàn)了用戶對(duì)幻燈片中的文本、圖形、表格等對(duì)象添加不同的動(dòng)畫效果。 一、進(jìn)入動(dòng)畫。進(jìn)入動(dòng)畫是對(duì)象從“無(wú)”到“有”。在觸發(fā)動(dòng)畫之前,被設(shè)置為“進(jìn)人”動(dòng)畫的對(duì)象是不出現(xiàn)的,在觸發(fā)之后,那它或它們采用何種方式出現(xiàn),就是“進(jìn)入”動(dòng)畫要解決的問(wèn)題。比如設(shè)置對(duì)象為“進(jìn)入”動(dòng)畫中的“擦除”效果,可以實(shí)現(xiàn)對(duì)象從某--方向一點(diǎn)點(diǎn)地出現(xiàn)的效果。進(jìn)入動(dòng)畫PPT中一般都是使用綠色圖標(biāo)標(biāo)識(shí)。 二、強(qiáng)調(diào)動(dòng)畫。強(qiáng)調(diào)動(dòng)畫是對(duì)象從“有”到“有”,前面的“有”是對(duì)象的初始狀態(tài),后面的“有”是對(duì)象的變化狀態(tài)。兩個(gè)狀態(tài)的變化,起到了對(duì)對(duì)象強(qiáng)調(diào)突出的目的。比如設(shè)置對(duì)象為“強(qiáng)調(diào)動(dòng)畫”中的“變大/變小”效果,可以實(shí)現(xiàn)對(duì)象從小到大(或設(shè)置從大到小)的變化過(guò)程,從而產(chǎn)生強(qiáng)調(diào)的效果。進(jìn)入動(dòng)畫PPT中一般都是使用黃色圖標(biāo)標(biāo)識(shí)。 三、退出動(dòng)畫。退出動(dòng)畫與進(jìn)入動(dòng)畫正好相反,它可以使對(duì)象從“有”到“無(wú)”。觸發(fā)后的動(dòng)畫效果與“進(jìn)入”效果正好相反,對(duì)象在沒(méi)有觸發(fā)動(dòng)畫之前,是存在屏幕上,而當(dāng)其被觸發(fā)后,則從屏幕上以某種設(shè)定的效果消失。如設(shè)置對(duì)象為退出動(dòng)畫中的“切出”效果,則對(duì)象在觸發(fā)后會(huì)逐漸地從屏幕上某處切出,從而消失在屏幕上。退出動(dòng)畫PPT中一般都是使用紅色圖標(biāo)標(biāo)識(shí)。 四、動(dòng)作路徑動(dòng)畫。就是對(duì)象沿著某條路徑運(yùn)動(dòng)的動(dòng)畫,在PPT中也可以制作出同樣的效果,就是將對(duì)象設(shè)置成“動(dòng)作路徑”效果。比如設(shè)置對(duì)象為“動(dòng)作路徑”中的“向右”效果,則對(duì)象在觸發(fā)后會(huì)沿著設(shè)定的方向線移動(dòng)。 動(dòng)畫的操控方法 選擇設(shè)置動(dòng)畫的對(duì)象,在“動(dòng)畫窗格”中,選擇一個(gè)動(dòng)畫,單擊右邊的下拉箭頭,彈出的下拉菜單。單擊“計(jì)時(shí)”選項(xiàng)中的“開始”按鈕,會(huì)彈出下拉列表框。 一、單擊開始。只有在多單擊一次鼠標(biāo)之后該動(dòng)畫才會(huì)出現(xiàn)。例如想要讓兩個(gè)對(duì)象逐一順序顯示,單擊一次出現(xiàn)一個(gè),再單擊一次再出現(xiàn)一個(gè),那么兩個(gè)出現(xiàn)動(dòng)作都應(yīng)該選擇“單擊開始”動(dòng)作選項(xiàng)。 二、從上一項(xiàng)開始。該動(dòng)作會(huì)和上一個(gè)動(dòng)作同時(shí)開始。例如把第一個(gè)對(duì)象設(shè)置為“單擊開始”,第二個(gè)對(duì)象設(shè)置為“從上一項(xiàng)開始”,那么單擊一次之后,兩個(gè)對(duì)象的動(dòng)畫會(huì)同時(shí)進(jìn)行。 三、從上一項(xiàng)之后開始。上一動(dòng)畫執(zhí)行完之后該動(dòng)作就會(huì)自動(dòng)執(zhí)行。對(duì)于兩個(gè)對(duì)象,如果第二個(gè)對(duì)象選擇了這個(gè)選項(xiàng),那么只需單擊一次,兩個(gè)對(duì)象的動(dòng)畫就會(huì)先后逐一進(jìn)行。 四、效果選項(xiàng)。單擊會(huì)打開“效果”選項(xiàng)卡。在這里,可以對(duì)動(dòng)作的屬性進(jìn)行調(diào)整。對(duì)于不同的動(dòng)作,此選項(xiàng)卡的內(nèi)容會(huì)有些差別。 最后是給各位職場(chǎng)人士的提示,千萬(wàn)不要為了追求PPT的美觀而忽略了其內(nèi)容的重要性,建議在掌握PPT設(shè)計(jì)技能前,將重點(diǎn)放在內(nèi)容表達(dá)上,利用常規(guī)的PPT操作做出滿足職場(chǎng)要求的作品才是正道。 %3Chowto_content%3E[{"type":"paragraph","attrs":{"is_abstract":true},"children":[{"type":"text","text":"為什么這個(gè)幻燈片背景不能修改?如何取消幻燈片的自動(dòng)播放?","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"……這些問(wèn)題經(jīng)常被職場(chǎng)小白問(wèn)起。這篇適合PPT小白快速入門的實(shí)用教程,目的是讓讀者學(xué)會(huì)、掌握、應(yīng)用PPT,達(dá)到知其然并知其所以然。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnKOoCgWy2s0OMecOun5J3Pg"},{"type":"heading","attrs":{"level":1},"children":[{"type":"text","text":"了解PPT","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcncCycMAUQGIuOq0CNT1ibEh"},{"type":"heading","attrs":{"level":2},"children":[{"type":"text","text":"初識(shí)PPT","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnkiM6GQIqosIo61E2J3Xxef"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"PPT是Office辦公組件中的一個(gè)軟件。使用PPT創(chuàng)作的文件叫演示文稿,可以在投影儀或電腦上進(jìn)行播放,也可將演示文稿打印出來(lái),供他人瀏覽閱讀。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcn2souogkOMiw0IQnH81UTVn"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"一般情況下,大眾喜愛(ài)的PPT通常都有一些相同的特點(diǎn):內(nèi)容準(zhǔn)確清晰,版式簡(jiǎn)潔大方,動(dòng)畫則恰到好處。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnqWwc6Wc26CAUW8SoYfLt5X"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"1、內(nèi)容準(zhǔn)確清晰。","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"PPT主要負(fù)責(zé)傳遞信息,所以需要嚴(yán)密的邏輯框架作為支撐。因此,通過(guò)看PPT的內(nèi)容邏輯是否準(zhǔn)確、清晰,就可以判斷PPT是好還是壞。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnU4McACmiE0GMQ9G4GkYzmh"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":918,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"初識(shí)PPT","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/ae234ea2f090450b96b44c75448c2bb3","width":1589},"text":"","id":"doxcnAYkIK4OiuIWma0WBsjVh3f"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"2、版式簡(jiǎn)潔大方。","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"PPT是用來(lái)傳達(dá)觀點(diǎn)的,所以不需要制作得太過(guò)復(fù)雜。一些初學(xué)者喜歡將各種各樣的元素都放入PPT中,結(jié)果作品的效果卻不盡如人意,觀眾也很難在雜亂無(wú)章的版式中獲取演講者所要表達(dá)的觀點(diǎn)。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcn0w8Ao8KYS6sUKsQaXKb9Bb"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":866,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"初識(shí)PPT","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/25a172d309a34e7b8281c19557f8d49d","width":1536},"text":"","id":"doxcnig6yuuYMSMwkWcv9hdWnBe"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"3、","id":""},{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"動(dòng)畫恰到好處。","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"在PPT中恰到好處的動(dòng)畫會(huì)起到錦上添花的作用,多余復(fù)雜的動(dòng)畫則容易喧賓奪主。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnoeca8EKGgaMcUhs5UnOd8d"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":1076,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"初識(shí)PPT","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/b5be636426c14c2ab054995ecf5ee087","width":1916},"text":"","id":"doxcnAgYo044cyaUwasHxuagvKd"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcn6yQsa02CYsEU2rlPEN3ULb"},{"type":"heading","attrs":{"level":2},"children":[{"type":"text","text":"了解PPT的結(jié)構(gòu)","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnAo6Gk6qUe0YuOTBsKfZ90D"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"一、PPT的操作界面","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnE4GaY0gqoQSSMqy6wNvgub"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"PPT的操作界面主要包括標(biāo)題欄、功能區(qū)、編輯區(qū)、文件菜單、視圖區(qū)和狀態(tài)欄。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcncqiee4mMM8gUot8OoU0DVe"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"1、標(biāo)題欄。","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"標(biāo)題欄位于頁(yè)面的最頂部,從左至右依次是快速訪問(wèn)工具欄、演示文稿名稱、登錄按鈕、功能區(qū)顯示選項(xiàng)按鈕、最小化按鈕、最大化按鈕和關(guān)閉按鈕。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcn2AOkUg0SoG4E0QyG5Zi8hf"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":1030,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"了解PPT的結(jié)構(gòu)","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/e6e314eb00f649ca8dcb20e8ac28e02d","width":1920},"text":"","id":"doxcnmciYGEOC82Ayyebpq5D2sz"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"2、功能區(qū)。","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"功能區(qū)位于標(biāo)題欄下方,默認(rèn)包含8個(gè)選項(xiàng)卡,每個(gè)選項(xiàng)卡中包含多個(gè)選項(xiàng)組,相同類別的命令通常集中在同一個(gè)選項(xiàng)組中。同一個(gè)選項(xiàng)卡中包含的命令按鈕也屬于同一種類型。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcngIgwY08WamqcY5WsTRSHRe"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":1033,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"了解PPT的結(jié)構(gòu)","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/a415114be5c1487986fc1cc286f088ee","width":1920},"text":"","id":"doxcn400eMsuSEu2oc9IAytHSzg"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"下面詳細(xì)介紹一下各選項(xiàng)卡的功能。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnMSkoMC2QKgwOQNJZc9ocnh"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"(1)“開始”選項(xiàng)卡。該選項(xiàng)卡中包括“剪貼板”“幻燈片”“字體”“段落”“繪圖”和“編輯”6個(gè)選項(xiàng)組。在此,用戶可以新建幻燈片,設(shè)置幻燈片的文本、段落以及樣式等。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnOwegsCEqMoUWg78WEKS8tg"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"(2)“插入”選項(xiàng)卡。該選項(xiàng)卡包括“幻燈片”“表格”“圖像”“插圖”“加載項(xiàng)”“鏈接”“批注”“文本”“符號(hào)”及“媒體”選項(xiàng)組。在此,用戶可以在幻燈片中插入各種表格、圖片、超鏈接、文本框、公式、音像等元素。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnUqGQeE2Ye24mCeFP6ZDANe"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"(3)“設(shè)計(jì)”選項(xiàng)卡。該選項(xiàng)卡包括:“主題”“變體”“自定義”選項(xiàng)組。在此,用戶可以對(duì)幻燈片的大小、背景格式等進(jìn)行設(shè)置。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnUE4ymcwGqauwwNIhfs8V8d"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"(4)“切換”選項(xiàng)卡。該選項(xiàng)卡包括“預(yù)覽”“切換到此幻燈片”“計(jì)時(shí)”選項(xiàng)組。在此,用戶可以為幻燈片設(shè)置各種切換效果。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcniCieeQoyCMmeyaIuoLknsg"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"(5)“動(dòng)畫”選項(xiàng)卡。該選項(xiàng)卡包括“預(yù)覽”“動(dòng)畫”“高級(jí)動(dòng)畫”和“計(jì)時(shí)”選項(xiàng)組。在此,用戶可以為其文本、圖片等添加各種動(dòng)畫效果。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnSy2EgOIGsCegGEvVGpQh7c"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"(6)“幻燈片放映”選項(xiàng)卡。該選項(xiàng)卡包括“開始放映幻燈片”“設(shè)置”“監(jiān)視器”選項(xiàng)組。在此,用戶可以對(duì)幻燈片的放映參數(shù)進(jìn)行設(shè)置。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnMsmU6YqG8QU2GcEvFh6qLb"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"(7)“審閱”選項(xiàng)卡。該選項(xiàng)卡包括“校對(duì)”“語(yǔ)言”“比較”“墨跡”選項(xiàng)組。在此,用戶可以對(duì)文字進(jìn)行批注、檢索、字體的簡(jiǎn)繁轉(zhuǎn)換等。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnogosEcQcI6oCeQOs1ShWch"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"(8)“視圖”選項(xiàng)卡。該選項(xiàng)卡包括“演示文稿視圖”“母版視圖”“顯示”“顯示比例”“窗口”和“宏”選項(xiàng)組。在此,用戶可以設(shè)置幻燈片的視圖模式、顯示標(biāo)尺和網(wǎng)格線等。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcneQ8gsGo4UecCK0v40ajkbe"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"3、編輯區(qū)。","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"編輯區(qū)位于整個(gè)頁(yè)面的中心位置,是演示文稿的工作區(qū)域。用戶可以在編輯區(qū)內(nèi)輸入文字、插入圖片、繪制圖形等。編輯區(qū)的顯示比例可以根據(jù)需要自由放大或縮小。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcn6qeeasK0CEs444bmvpPaNc"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":1032,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"了解PPT的結(jié)構(gòu)","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/1cbde2a4d1da4ebaa955540b38d20aaf","width":1920},"text":"","id":"doxcnGuG2mY06eqWyC6mzMhAKVh"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"4、“文件”菜單。","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"單擊界面左上角的“文件”菜單按鈕,可以打開“文件”菜單,該菜單中包含“信息”“新建”“打開”“保存”“另存為”“打印”“共享”“導(dǎo)出”“關(guān)閉”“帳戶”等12個(gè)選項(xiàng)。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcny0oY4eu6UcYU8zfCZS8EFh"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":1031,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"了解PPT的結(jié)構(gòu)","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/673b68f4aac44569bede0490cc0a7309","width":1920},"text":"","id":"doxcneOEm6SyWKgmqKaBTUuKjRd"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"5、","id":""},{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"狀態(tài)欄。","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"狀態(tài)欄位于界面最底部,從左到右依次顯示的命令有“幻燈片頁(yè)數(shù)”“當(dāng)前顯示頁(yè)碼”“拼寫檢索”按鈕、“語(yǔ)言”“備注”按鈕、“批注”按鈕、“視圖”按鈕、“幻燈片放映”按鈕、“視圖縮放欄”等。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnMgIAgaaYYqImaryleEmWn3"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":1039,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"了解PPT的結(jié)構(gòu)","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/f9d18b99af964c5397e06c01ed0e6b8c","width":1920},"text":"","id":"doxcnawwMqISOoiuuquQBX4SBTd"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"二、完整的PPT構(gòu)成","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcn2gYkSkcEMe062maSA7oXfb"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"一份完整的PPT包含5部分,分別為標(biāo)題頁(yè)、目錄頁(yè)、過(guò)渡頁(yè)、內(nèi)容頁(yè)和結(jié)尾頁(yè),下面將分別對(duì)其進(jìn)行詳細(xì)介紹。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnwMUGmo6Qk6G0muv0eaW3Zc"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"1、標(biāo)題頁(yè)。","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"標(biāo)題頁(yè)決定觀眾的第一印象,如果標(biāo)題頁(yè)設(shè)計(jì)不好,則很難吸引觀眾的眼球。標(biāo)題頁(yè)可以是圖片+文字的形式,也可以是純文字形式。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnKCoIWi8EC6kw4OywH2UOZd"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"(1)圖片+文字。以圖片為主的標(biāo)題頁(yè),具有較強(qiáng)的感染力,如果再加上富有震撼力的標(biāo)題文字,那就更容易吸引觀眾的視線了。這種形式的標(biāo)題頁(yè)需要注意的一個(gè)問(wèn)題是所選的圖片一定要是高清圖片。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnY06QMiW4e0mIsV7IiRRMFf"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":852,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"了解PPT的結(jié)構(gòu)","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/d11f8d3e0c814441bdbf212822048e36","width":1523},"text":"","id":"doxcnOMQgeKq0KsQECIswu6ovBg"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"(2)純文字。純文字的標(biāo)題頁(yè),需要考慮排版問(wèn)題。建議初學(xué)者盡量不要嘗試。有時(shí)為了避免頁(yè)面版式空洞,可以適當(dāng)添加一些形狀來(lái)修飾。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnyyAiMu0UKeMmsBLmFS0Dgh"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":804,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"了解PPT的結(jié)構(gòu)","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/45563f480ef04dc4b83ae78c9449f407","width":1624},"text":"","id":"doxcncYw2KiCQsiESOg7ISv9Mtc"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"2、目錄頁(yè)。","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"一般情況下,目錄頁(yè)緊隨標(biāo)題頁(yè)之后。目錄頁(yè)可讓觀眾了解PPT的大致內(nèi)容。目錄頁(yè)的表現(xiàn)形式有多種,下面將分別對(duì)其進(jìn)行介紹。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnqmG0oY6SMaSQcR3xY0kAAg"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"(1)利用形狀。目錄頁(yè)簡(jiǎn)潔明了,能突出重點(diǎn)即可,所以使用形狀是不錯(cuò)的選擇。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnu28YggyeeesqqSQ7gpCcfe"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":880,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"了解PPT的結(jié)構(gòu)","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/292e5d227792479db817fabf505595ff","width":1621},"text":"","id":"doxcnmUIk0Gk8yUaKikF4unoOPg"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"(2)利用PNG圖標(biāo)。使用圖標(biāo),可以幫助觀眾更好地記憶內(nèi)容,并且看起來(lái)簡(jiǎn)潔清爽,不會(huì)喧賓奪主。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnoAykwUkg40YgWUVg2VWwRg"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":919,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"了解PPT的結(jié)構(gòu)","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/b96171d40b324deeb72d0d63a02bec9f","width":1582},"text":"","id":"doxcniiIWUSsO4CO0iU3aJzhWSc"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"(3)利用圖片。將目錄與圖片結(jié)合起來(lái),能有效打破頁(yè)面的平淡無(wú)奇,給人眼前一亮的感覺(jué)。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnwWYKgAECCE0yMBcB3sQiBg"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":878,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"了解PPT的結(jié)構(gòu)","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/093ab36feda94ad78209fe48b981cdad","width":1625},"text":"","id":"doxcnEs4YkOqKOW4qCUElpOlkXf"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"3、過(guò)渡頁(yè)。","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"如果PPT的頁(yè)數(shù)較多,可以在其中添加過(guò)渡頁(yè),這樣可以給觀眾一個(gè)短暫的休息時(shí)間。當(dāng)然如果PPT的頁(yè)數(shù)較少,就沒(méi)有必要添加了,可以根據(jù)實(shí)際情況而定。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnuIsaASIwQeyQcd0jHzEI2b"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":914,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"了解PPT的結(jié)構(gòu)","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/ef1f47ba416f44779effba669b29c286","width":1583},"text":"","id":"doxcnCY20QUACSsQqkdnWhjvyZc"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"4、內(nèi)容頁(yè)。","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"內(nèi)容頁(yè)是整個(gè)PPT中必不可少的,也是最重要的一部分,多以圖文結(jié)合的頁(yè)面形式來(lái)傳達(dá)內(nèi)容。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnQaW46kUYuUMOA525y9fjxe"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":806,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"了解PPT的結(jié)構(gòu)","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/aade9aa23f514f3bae935871d24872c6","width":1588},"text":"","id":"doxcnuaICgw2We26kCGRJd0Wddg"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"5、結(jié)尾頁(yè)。","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"結(jié)束頁(yè)可以寫一些激勵(lì)性或感謝性的文字,或是表達(dá)美好祝愿的話語(yǔ)。同時(shí)要注意與PPT的整體風(fēng)格相呼應(yīng)。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnuc22yaey4CgS46lBycsRVd"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":879,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"了解PPT的結(jié)構(gòu)","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/fadff9472f76484ab3008c5db1f72852","width":1624},"text":"","id":"doxcnMUMOuUYY4akEWCyB7abH9c"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"三、PPT與幻燈片的關(guān)系","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcni2CGiIKiWIS2eusne4MDOc"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"PPT又叫演示文稿,格式后綴為.ppt、.pptx。演示文稿中的每一頁(yè)就叫幻燈片,每張幻燈片都是演示文稿中既相互獨(dú)立又相互聯(lián)系的內(nèi)容。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnAEwM2oQgoCoogTdRUPkYyg"},{"type":"heading","attrs":{"level":2},"children":[{"type":"text","text":"PPT的基本操作","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnKYAumSUOqqkAwvb2vnIgIg"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"對(duì)PPT結(jié)構(gòu)有所了解后,接下來(lái)就要了解一下PPT的基本操作了。PPT的基本操作包括創(chuàng)建演示文稿、保存演示文稿、打開和關(guān)閉演示文稿、查看演示文稿等,下面分別對(duì)其進(jìn)行詳細(xì)介紹。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnCGAQCMWC0Coe2TxNeiv7jh"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"1、輕松創(chuàng)建文稿","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnmoG0sOauU0OS2fpp81A2Jh"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"創(chuàng)建PPT的方法有多種,下面以創(chuàng)建模板PPT為例,向用戶介紹具體的操作方法。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnIEg2KiImEOoooL7k2NbXAf"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步驟1:雙擊PowerPoint應(yīng)用程序快捷圖標(biāo),啟動(dòng)軟件,在打開界面右側(cè)的搜索框中輸入需要搜索模板的類型,然后單擊“開始搜索”按鈕。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnYmGqyg4aCWcIcrQzRAZUuf"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":1031,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"PPT的基本操作","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/bf8baa03fce84b80b4aaf19335be1818","width":1920},"text":"","id":"doxcn4UY88oUQaIwEWyAJSXo9ve"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步驟2:隨即在新建界面中顯示出所有搜索到的模板,單擊選擇需要的模板。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnWcuSUQOAaMISchr5Wl6Hph"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":1030,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"PPT的基本操作","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/dfbbce5aeaff45b7bbc99a133ed49950","width":1919},"text":"","id":"doxcnaiwoIqwq8ySCo1704NUJih"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步驟3:彈出模板詳情窗口,接著單擊“創(chuàng)建”按鈕。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnwMCYiKSCCYQ2sZDTcvafkf"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":1034,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"PPT的基本操作","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/b3b1e0039d474b42a670075cff24699e","width":1918},"text":"","id":"doxcnsqI0w2g40KCIiQtY8QvRRc"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步驟4:系統(tǒng)開始下載該模板,下載完成后會(huì)自動(dòng)打開該模板,即可創(chuàng)建一個(gè)模板PPT。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnWicsMK6oU8CkYG1Edd6Ppb"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":1029,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"PPT的基本操作","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/e928708208fc4fb8a88b89eeb7ed2c01","width":1920},"text":"","id":"doxcnIIgSo6cCos8E4sl0pT8X0d"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"2、","id":""},{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"保存與另存為","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcn2GaAkiCIgkAAorFNWke1Eg"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"在創(chuàng)建演示文稿后,需要將其保存,以免因?yàn)橐馔鈹嚯娀螂娔X死機(jī),而造成文件內(nèi)容丟失。在創(chuàng)建演示文稿后,如果用戶是第一次執(zhí)行保存操作,則可以按照以下方法進(jìn)行保存。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnGuwqOsQOI8ocExIBQhUPLe"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步驟1:在演示文稿界面,單擊“文件”菜單按鈕。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnuuImIuA4mMOoAvYOFAybRd"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":1035,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"PPT的基本操作","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/3451d7cf327f42e2a6de7c7209035d45","width":1920},"text":"","id":"doxcnieCYqmuAQiWmGmW44sqvGd"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步驟2:在打開的“文件”菜單窗口中選擇“另存為”選項(xiàng),在右側(cè)選擇“瀏覽”選項(xiàng)。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcna24acOAcSiKgWioDnfNyah"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":1033,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"PPT的基本操作","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/e21daf5f9cbf4c45853597383f3a0a58","width":1920},"text":"","id":"doxcnUO8seOoi6ugSyOGLnRdh8g"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步驟3:打開“另存為”對(duì)話框,從中選擇保存的位置,修改“文件名”,單擊“保存”按鈕。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnYQKmSo68MQAGQZ5Jm2Dlug"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":1031,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"PPT的基本操作","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/f8cf4d9f77c54c78920a41f339b79aa3","width":1920},"text":"","id":"doxcnsSKAGGKGIS6KuMkSkfxRqe"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步驟4:返回演示文稿,此時(shí)可以看到,標(biāo)題欄中即顯示修改后的演示文稿的名稱。當(dāng)用戶執(zhí)行保存操作后,若對(duì)演示文稿進(jìn)行了修改和編輯,直接單擊“保存”按鈕即可對(duì)其保存。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnyqEY26mukUuoYR7AZu1Vob"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"3、打開與關(guān)閉操作","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnwg6m2omQA40SI35xBaqbOf"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"打開演示文稿的操作方法其實(shí)很簡(jiǎn)單,除了雙擊文件圖標(biāo)外,還可以按照以下幾種方法進(jìn)行操作。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnksSS2mawwwcCcZnykzMwNd"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"(1)右鍵打開法。打開文件所在的文件夾,單擊選中需要打開的演示文稿,然后單擊鼠標(biāo)右鍵,從彈出的快捷菜單中選擇“打開”命令,即可打開所選的演示文稿。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnsQIm6k8uEy2SYZzX1f1jSd"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"(2)打開計(jì)算機(jī)中的演示文稿。還可以利用已打開的演示文稿選擇計(jì)算機(jī)中的其他演示文稿,具體操作如下:","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnEQCkKkGQUSUSUf9M1RVVJc"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步驟1:在打開的演示文稿中單擊“文件”菜單按鈕。(也可以通過(guò)","id":""},{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"Ctrl+O快捷鍵","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"打開計(jì)算機(jī)中的演示文稿,這種方法更加方便快捷。)","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnSOQWEoymoKIoKapFgTJ83c"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步驟2:進(jìn)入“文件”菜單,選擇“打開”選項(xiàng),并在右側(cè)選擇“瀏覽”選項(xiàng)。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnSEwAQMm2oQ2kKOnJ5Neqwf"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步驟3:彈出“打開”對(duì)話框,選中需要打開的演示文稿,然后單擊“打開”按鈕,即可打開選中的演示文稿。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcngK6s4KiICqw86lPFX4Vtod"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"4、查看演示文稿","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnCqWIiwSQWq6Qgt4USH2V4g"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"在制作完演示文稿后,為了確保內(nèi)容的準(zhǔn)確性,可以對(duì)演示文稿中的內(nèi)容進(jìn)行查看。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcn0gCCaUsYGkIKUHFN2443vf"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"(1)普通視圖。在普通視圖下,將光標(biāo)移到編輯區(qū)上方,滑動(dòng)鼠標(biāo)滾輪可以對(duì)幻燈片的內(nèi)容進(jìn)行查看,或者將光標(biāo)放在右側(cè)的滑塊上,拖動(dòng)鼠標(biāo)查看PPT中的內(nèi)容。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnGucuIIIsOqEaio5UoAWh1d"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":1033,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"PPT的基本操作","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/84462995dc384bfaa99ec61fe58e89cd","width":1920},"text":"","id":"doxcn6umYe2e6Q6M6UOoHtgk7t1"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"(2)幻燈片瀏覽。在狀態(tài)欄中單擊“幻燈片瀏覽”按鈕,可在瀏覽模式中對(duì)演示文稿中所有幻燈片進(jìn)行查看。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnqWEU8YSyQkqg2z6nEEw5db"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":1028,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"PPT的基本操作","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/6396a33250ac481c88f21256e51756e9","width":1920},"text":"","id":"doxcnWgawy8CSek4KoNo5oeWUGf"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"(3)閱讀視圖。在狀態(tài)欄中單擊“閱讀視圖”按鈕,即可進(jìn)入放映預(yù)覽狀態(tài),在這種狀態(tài)下,用戶可以對(duì)幻燈片中的內(nèi)容和動(dòng)畫效果進(jìn)行查看。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnOAkg0o26u2aSum1hIfTLdf"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":1029,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"PPT的基本操作","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/87af1049b75d4340bfb408fafad3924a","width":1916},"text":"","id":"doxcnekqeGAKgagSUmCVh4xCX7b"},{"type":"heading","attrs":{"level":2},"children":[{"type":"text","text":"幻燈片的基本操作","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcn2CM4qeKiyWIYodog1J4rKh"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"前面介紹了演示文稿的基本操作,接下來(lái)學(xué)習(xí)一下幻燈片的基本操作,包括選擇幻燈片、新建幻燈片、移動(dòng)與復(fù)制幻燈片、隱藏與刪除幻燈片、更改幻燈片的背景等。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcn0cwYEWKuwQkSkrgp5cHR4e"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"一、選擇幻燈片","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcn6WOusuiIksm8UpopxhtcXg"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"1、選擇單個(gè)幻燈片。","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"如果想選擇單個(gè)幻燈片,則只需在預(yù)覽區(qū)域單擊所需幻燈片,即可將其選中。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnu0AWSAi8cCYOyOD3pjdWSb"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":1028,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"幻燈片的基本操作","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/a4982cdb8c4a4acfab760a69ba4e8e03","width":1920},"text":"","id":"doxcngMSMUkS0Mq4oCCvnVnJ48g"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"2、選擇不連續(xù)的幻燈片。","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"按住Ctrl鍵不放,在預(yù)覽區(qū)域中依次用鼠標(biāo)單擊多個(gè)幻燈片,即可將不連續(xù)的幻燈片選中。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnie80Gqqiwgmsn47OMr7RzC"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":1029,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"幻燈片的基本操作","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/c4267f7ea0ff49ccb4576142e9680c67","width":1920},"text":"","id":"doxcnCsCoc62g6KcoOKY5amcEgg"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"3、選擇連續(xù)的幻燈片。","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"按住Shift鍵,在預(yù)覽區(qū)域中單擊任意兩個(gè)不相鄰的幻燈片,即可將它們之間的所有幻燈片選中。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnOokKsomiIisUQpjiEbmjGf"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":1027,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"幻燈片的基本操作","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/0ac6b0160e214c42adeb1318bc6624e6","width":1920},"text":"","id":"doxcn0UcIgMuoesIiohcCGRAZld"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"4、選擇全部幻燈片。","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"首先單擊預(yù)覽區(qū)域中任意幻燈片,然后按Ctrl+A組合鍵,即可將全部幻燈片選中。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcng4usUGIs4e8kGVz4cXAE44"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":1029,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"幻燈片的基本操作","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/31a45a5d7c6041339c3fc900c08f04a6","width":1917},"text":"","id":"doxcn24sGWaMCeeasE3AmFwG30b"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"二、新建幻燈片","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnScyM0UiqAAQU0O3FxjQyzm"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"若演示文稿中的幻燈片太少,不能滿足編輯需求,則用戶可以在演示文稿中新建幻燈片。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnAeE0YuiQ6GSmOieOUEbJlf"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步驟1:打開演示文稿,選中任意一張幻燈片,在“開始”選項(xiàng)卡中單擊“新建幻燈片”下拉按鈕,從列表中選擇“空白”選項(xiàng)。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnkW60C6maaMQcMHDZwiHdCh"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步驟2:被選中的幻燈片下方隨即新建一個(gè)“空白”版式的幻燈片。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnkO2QCkEu2yqqsnmesdMnZd"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步驟3:若在下拉列表中選擇“兩欄內(nèi)容”選項(xiàng)。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnOgYOYecyYOKGM3819gv2Pf"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步驟4:即可新建“兩欄內(nèi)容”版式的幻燈片。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnmAcyCkW4sokSWGsj6M6J2f"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"注:還可以通過(guò)右鍵菜單功能來(lái)新建幻燈片,即選擇任意幻燈片,單擊鼠標(biāo)右鍵,從彈出的快捷菜單中選擇“新建幻燈片”命令,即可新建—個(gè)幻燈片。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnoGUUumWwuKakmO7oVYBwBe"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"三、移動(dòng)與復(fù)制幻燈片","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnuuA2k6oegg48Sc8X3XgGQf"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"在編輯演示文稿的過(guò)程中,如果覺(jué)得幻燈片的順序不合理,可以移動(dòng)幻燈片來(lái)調(diào)整其順序。若需要添加相同格式的幻燈片,則可以復(fù)制幻燈片,下面將介紹幾種移動(dòng)與復(fù)制幻燈片的方法。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnq4OIC2KQG4eqiKAIb7Pwrc"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"1、移動(dòng)幻燈片。","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"可以按照以下幾種方法移動(dòng)幻燈片:","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcn0ECEKOwmS8isGS8ZNjvRvg"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"(1)功能區(qū)按鈕移動(dòng)","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnOGsyyc0iaIwEPTQR4JZgnj"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步驟1:選擇需要移動(dòng)的幻燈片,在“開始”選項(xiàng)卡中單擊“剪切”按鈕。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnGwa6UmCEuO2agBuOOtvGdd"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":1032,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"幻燈片的基本操作","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/dde34e8c6e7b465780c4270a7dcb2530","width":1915},"text":"","id":"doxcnsiA0ms6SIwKiCciHXidcuh"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步驟2:將光標(biāo)定位至需要移動(dòng)到的位置,單擊“粘貼”下拉按鈕,從列表中選擇“使用目標(biāo)主題”選項(xiàng)。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcn6asUkwiKm2G0FQod5FXmNy"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":1035,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"幻燈片的基本操作","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/e949dac2154c45ca8f70307718266da6","width":1920},"text":"","id":"doxcnMeICsK4Akg6G2RQNywhvhc"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步驟3:隨即將所選幻燈片移動(dòng)到目標(biāo)位置。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcn2mce0CgSagoqCmZrqePTnb"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":1035,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"幻燈片的基本操作","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/671cdb039813406fbd0a1bde70890f63","width":1920},"text":"","id":"doxcnGO6gK4oeOkE0TfOBwTefmk"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"(2)鼠標(biāo)拖動(dòng)移動(dòng)","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnoAuEYSqqoyOewZAT3FZpud"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步驟1:選擇需要的幻燈片,然后按住鼠標(biāo)左鍵不放,拖動(dòng)鼠標(biāo)至合適位置。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnkyY8O0yAi6IgScCZ2qAGWg"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":1034,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"幻燈片的基本操作","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/c4e015e30d8f4885a2d14084757837f1","width":1920},"text":"","id":"doxcncUU6aESEUeomQRLdt0uU1f"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步驟2:釋放鼠標(biāo)左鍵,即可完成幻燈片的移動(dòng)。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnQCmoW2wGYc2iMhpGtQJQrc"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":1029,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"幻燈片的基本操作","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/1bd31b33dd3743f2a4f2195b892cafdd","width":1920},"text":"","id":"doxcnQe60yAeMeaQ2oHRbJZw5ih"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"2、復(fù)制幻燈片","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcns6AgEeY4YK86CJQwfn2Y6L"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"若用戶想要添加相同格式的幻燈片,則可以利用復(fù)制功能來(lái)實(shí)現(xiàn),下面介紹幾種復(fù)制幻燈片的方法。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcn0YCoW6EwY4WUMDFHfgLTCg"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"(1)功能區(qū)按鈕復(fù)制","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnQkqqW82IUwGkYZVCUJNmAd"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步驟1:選擇需要復(fù)制的幻燈片,在“開始”選項(xiàng)卡中單擊“復(fù)制”按鈕。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnWAEmOgqu2CqC0MAKClREqf"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步驟2:在需要粘貼的位置插入光標(biāo),單擊“粘貼”下拉按鈕,從列表中選擇“使用目標(biāo)主題”選項(xiàng)即可。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnk4eSWMIe8IccumvoySFp6g"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步驟3:此時(shí)在該位置可顯示所復(fù)制的幻燈片。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnwcIC2sQso0W2AZpd2M7PSd"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"(2)右鍵快捷菜單復(fù)制","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnqugKeYUMiKkqAFznZMGo6e"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"選擇幻燈片后,單擊鼠標(biāo)右鍵,從彈出的快捷菜單中選擇“復(fù)制幻燈片”命令即可。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnCGE8aQqGwKwuM1B2zSe9Fd"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"(3)鼠標(biāo)+鍵盤復(fù)制","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcn4gC2mu8IamOS8oWXy2vlRb"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"選擇需要復(fù)制的幻燈片,并按住鼠標(biāo)左鍵不放,接著在鍵盤上按住Ctrl鍵,然后拖動(dòng)鼠標(biāo)至合適位置,釋放鼠標(biāo)左鍵后松開Ctrl鍵,即可復(fù)制選擇的幻燈片。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnw2S8wSyyyKcSOkjYlOQjZb"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"四、隱藏與顯示幻燈片","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcn28sAsOogQgCEY3bjjD1Ngh"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"如果不想播放某張幻燈片,但又不想將其刪除,則可以將該幻燈片隱藏起來(lái)。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcny0M8UESMSwmQwDmDL8Su3b"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步驟1:選擇需要隱藏的幻燈片,這里選擇第2張幻燈片,切換至“幻燈片放映”選項(xiàng)卡,單擊“隱藏幻燈片”按鈕。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnYE6Y6eQuCmSAc0txEHdNfb"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":1032,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"幻燈片的基本操作","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/ca42f556a8814bb0aec8628874fe324f","width":1918},"text":"","id":"doxcnKyKOouiiueyiaGiKSIrSvg"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步驟2:此時(shí),可以看到所選幻燈片的左上角出現(xiàn)了隱藏符號(hào)。如果想要顯示隱藏的幻燈片,則需要再次單擊“隱藏幻燈片”按鈕,即可將隱藏的幻燈片顯示出來(lái)。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcns24SKIyYKa8QsxPMEEaD3c"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":1034,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"幻燈片的基本操作","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/a402c81d53dd43378b6997e016ac07ff","width":1915},"text":"","id":"doxcnskYEYomU6S08KgKbMhj8Df"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"注:還可以通過(guò)","id":""},{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"右鍵菜單","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"來(lái)隱藏幻燈片,即選擇需要隱藏的幻燈片,單擊鼠標(biāo)右鍵,從彈出的快捷菜單中選擇“隱藏幻燈片”命令,即可將選擇的幻燈片隱藏起來(lái)。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnowGsuYAaCEsQcypHlmsJdb"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":1031,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"幻燈片的基本操作","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/7ddbdf155d964815933e6ed717b4efb1","width":1920},"text":"","id":"doxcnEgKqQMAkcSSU8UMyeoZIgc"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"五、刪除幻燈片","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnk8Q8cIWO8MOOS0lmuGFkVg"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"當(dāng)演示文稿中的幻燈片較多,有些內(nèi)容多余,想精減時(shí),可以將冗余的幻燈片刪除。下面介紹兩種刪除幻燈片的方法。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnWkW8IU0ECmiQGFL6lRrPcb"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"1、右鍵菜單法。","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"選擇需要?jiǎng)h除的幻燈片,然后單擊鼠標(biāo)右鍵,從彈出的快捷菜單中選擇“刪除幻燈片”命令,即可將選擇的幻燈片刪除。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnkMYuoQsUqweESgsv91rcbb"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"2、快捷鍵法。","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"選擇需要?jiǎng)h除的幻燈片,然后直接在鍵盤上按Delete鍵,即可將所選幻燈片刪除。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnUqkw42KwWcQga8i9ws0leh"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"六、調(diào)整幻燈片大小","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnWQsMMmoKsIy6oUrV0eJJxB"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"默認(rèn)的幻燈片大小為寬屏(16:9),用戶也可以根據(jù)需要自定義幻燈片的大小,下面介紹具體的操作方法。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnqkuC2EokUgUKx0BBTyHpKn"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步驟1:選擇幻燈片,切換至“設(shè)計(jì)”選項(xiàng)卡,單擊“幻燈片大小”下拉按鈕,從中選擇“自定義幻燈片大小”選項(xiàng)。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnUWmYa8SYoCG6cDMmWAdgee"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":1034,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"幻燈片的基本操作","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/a8553e2b803949bfac7a7b16819440ba","width":1910},"text":"","id":"doxcn2ySAkqAQeooWqEnpNtyMZg"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步驟2:打開“幻燈片大小”對(duì)話框,在“幻燈片大小”下拉列表中選擇“自定義”選項(xiàng),設(shè)置“寬度”和“高度”值,單擊“確定”按鈕。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnIoeUUGo622uAoRQWdjeNTc"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":1032,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"幻燈片的基本操作","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/a4a2d03e36594676b5ae19e71e0e0ef0","width":1920},"text":"","id":"doxcnqSk2MUmKmGqeW1Rd6cntht"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步驟3:彈出相應(yīng)的對(duì)話框,從中選擇“確保適合”選項(xiàng)。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnwUgaCiKkQK0iCgiH0R4AQd"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":1029,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"幻燈片的基本操作","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/d7ffa75f470b4d83ad3867833acd6b1c","width":1920},"text":"","id":"doxcnAIgO4cYEk8ia68rZX60mAf"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步驟4:此時(shí),可以看到幻燈片的尺寸隨即被調(diào)整為自定義的大小。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnaaWiQk6EoU0GesWgiHLbwf"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":1032,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"幻燈片的基本操作","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/e73708959b76474aa91690d4c1b0ae0d","width":1920},"text":"","id":"doxcnqOUGIY2ASSI6SsXeFZKyAb"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"注:也可以直接在","id":""},{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"“幻燈片大小”下拉列表","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"中選擇“標(biāo)準(zhǔn)”選項(xiàng),快速更改幻燈片的大小。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnaCm4GSSSSIGY4djRIXfbPg"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"七、更改幻燈片的背景","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnOiucoaEs2US4W8yxCk3Yjg"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"如果對(duì)當(dāng)前幻燈片的背景不滿意,可以對(duì)其進(jìn)行更改。具體操作方法如下:","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnKa8kEaeE62AKv3XrHwS7JO"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步驟1:選擇幻燈片,在“設(shè)計(jì)”選項(xiàng)卡中單擊“設(shè)置背景格式”按鈕。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnO0acy2yOqIy2YTDGvJNd4j"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步驟2:彈出“設(shè)置背景格式”窗格,切換至“填充”選項(xiàng)卡,在“填充”組中選中“圖片或紋理填充”單選按鈕,接著單擊下方的“文件”按鈕。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnYKMQW0SM46WqyQrsLYUc8b"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步驟3:打開“插入圖片”對(duì)話框,選擇圖片后單擊“插入”按鈕。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnYW0iacAgOmSEKmzWmQsSFf"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步驟4:關(guān)閉窗格,此時(shí)可以看到幻燈片的背景更改為圖片背景的效果了。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnSgUAoS2yyAqwC6mS11XrJe"},{"type":"heading","attrs":{"level":1},"children":[{"type":"text","text":"版式設(shè)計(jì)","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnkYMs8Q8AYmWyk9AJjLMkqf"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"了解PPT的基本操作后,用戶可以制作出簡(jiǎn)單的演示文稿,但如果想制作出精美大氣的作品,則需要對(duì)版式進(jìn)行一番設(shè)計(jì)。本節(jié)將對(duì)PPT的版式設(shè)計(jì)、模板的運(yùn)用、PPT的配色等進(jìn)行全面介紹。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnEYWm42y28KAI2RYX3bcjKh"},{"type":"heading","attrs":{"level":2},"children":[{"type":"text","text":"PPT版式設(shè)計(jì)原則","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnU4GKAA6QQcSiI32lVVA9X2"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"一、什么樣的頁(yè)面版式才好看","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnAAQEia2iuIcUqGElucio6g"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"好看的頁(yè)面版式會(huì)遵循親近、對(duì)比、對(duì)齊和重復(fù)這4項(xiàng)原則。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnUauOOgqG88sga8UGetd19c"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"1、親近","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcn8uKGMEyCkweO8y8xJXuKwb"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"內(nèi)容上有關(guān)聯(lián)的要靠近,沒(méi)有關(guān)聯(lián)的要遠(yuǎn)離,同時(shí)要統(tǒng)一各段落的間隔。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcn8Y60GkyiKEGc4kBQUeya4b"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":729,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"PPT版式設(shè)計(jì)原則","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/83f798a2630a40c49d62da9137bbd06f","width":1298},"text":"","id":"doxcnKGOMQQY8Gc4qWsdaFshyec"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"2、對(duì)齊","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnSQMSOSS8q2u0KARm07dR2b"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"各層之間要對(duì)齊,因?yàn)槊恳粋(gè)元素都與頁(yè)面上的某項(xiàng)內(nèi)容存在某種視覺(jué)聯(lián)系,如果隨意安放,則會(huì)顯得混亂。但頁(yè)面中有很多個(gè)關(guān)鍵字時(shí),打破對(duì)齊也能產(chǎn)生不一樣的視覺(jué)效果。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcn6k4cqQ0QYwiIAZhqgaBOWf"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":725,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"PPT版式設(shè)計(jì)原則","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/9ccdf4c291ae4fa2afe3e5aa72ba347f","width":1299},"text":"","id":"doxcnGy0qaYySg6s8OC21CMJKlg"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"3、對(duì)比","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnuMO0uk6eSY4yuC1KaSKfre"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"對(duì)比的方法有3種:文字對(duì)比、顏色對(duì)比和圖形對(duì)比。通過(guò)對(duì)比可以迅速吸引觀眾的眼球。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcns4uCGaQAmqSYQlNf78nrwd"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"下圖則通過(guò)圖形色塊來(lái)區(qū)分各項(xiàng)內(nèi)容。當(dāng)觀眾看到這張幻燈片內(nèi)容時(shí),會(huì)立即被黃色色塊的內(nèi)容吸引住。這里需要提醒一點(diǎn)的是,對(duì)比的力度一定要大,否則就不要用。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnIqoGEiwAwYqYAFXnQnzGtd"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":849,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"PPT版式設(shè)計(jì)原則","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/c8b7fa1718de4d549f926b60dfac2073","width":1519},"text":"","id":"doxcnUy20Wm4YKuIOacJOF52FSd"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"4、重復(fù)","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnOKowoIE0AUqsOkX9wFXcZf"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"通過(guò)讓PPT的部分元素,例如圖片、字體、配色等重復(fù)使用,可以使PPT的版式風(fēng)格統(tǒng)一,避免雜亂無(wú)章。但需要注意的是,不要一味地單調(diào)重復(fù),要明確每個(gè)頁(yè)面的作用。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnGsocOCCaqAgYIvimCGcUTc"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"(1)標(biāo)題頁(yè)","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcngwCwCuiSuKq6aEZsaEwx5f"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":727,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"PPT版式設(shè)計(jì)原則","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/a349f361ddcd4798bc02254556ff3d06","width":1269},"text":"","id":"doxcnmQukUYMkEWWGk7pmih7tsd"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"(2)目錄頁(yè)","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnqYcAaS0gw06QojDZGJExUd"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":726,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"PPT版式設(shè)計(jì)原則","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/fd98e48abb8d4041ba026bf7e687a5ea","width":1263},"text":"","id":"doxcniEq6oe46meiWwxyGfudbqe"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"(3)內(nèi)容頁(yè)","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnuGiy4WAe8umEEnpkEtpRaf"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":723,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"PPT版式設(shè)計(jì)原則","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/13e9831eb2c74f8281194105a9dd2687","width":1282},"text":"","id":"doxcn0Cou8C0sMEm6UXd7UTbuyg"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"(4)結(jié)尾頁(yè)","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcn6SquoiqO62qQgTPchcYRfh"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":719,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"PPT版式設(shè)計(jì)原則","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/31ac79adc67b4a41bca79585fc8634ed","width":1268},"text":"","id":"doxcngymkqqUa0wSo2JEnK9wO5g"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"二、PPT中的留白藝術(shù)","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnwcM22SgacOKk6AanoRhX7f"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"留白留出的是空間。對(duì)于幻燈片而言,最直觀的好處就是用戶可以輕易地添加文字,保證文字信息不受干擾,和圖片一起傳遞信息。另外,留白具有與生俱來(lái)的雅致、高端、文藝、輕盈、簡(jiǎn)約氣質(zhì)。下面就向讀者介紹在PPT中人為留白的3種方法。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnKyi6mMuCI4uAJty8TIb4xf"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"1、尋找簡(jiǎn)單的背景圖。","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"盡量用簡(jiǎn)單的圖片作為幻燈片背景,然后添加與主題相關(guān)的關(guān)鍵字即可。當(dāng)然尋找的圖片也應(yīng)當(dāng)與主題相關(guān)才行。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnYOg62kw40iSsYvSraKl5hh"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":851,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"PPT版式設(shè)計(jì)原則","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/dfa1577c011b4e1b9af0511c59a41517","width":1521},"text":"","id":"doxcnMq28yoSwwqeyKik0HR1S1b"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"2、利用形狀襯托關(guān)鍵字。","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"利用精致的圖片作為背景,使用矩形覆蓋背景某區(qū)域,以作為文字的底襯,在矩形框中輸入文字即可。該矩形框可填充顏色,也可提高它的透明度。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnWiK4uYMcwo22IjUqt6Mn8d"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":770,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"PPT版式設(shè)計(jì)原則","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/536ea5f50e154a3f896775348ce5b8c1","width":1368},"text":"","id":"doxcnEGKEWqoIGcwsAtHI6zUEAd"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"3、減少頁(yè)面信息量。","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"留出空白其實(shí)就是做減法。減去多余的,留出關(guān)鍵的信息即可。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcniY4W0CqAIYc0yM1aY9Ngkg"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":861,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"PPT版式設(shè)計(jì)原則","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/9239d42c32424080b916c1905fea7c71","width":1524},"text":"","id":"doxcn6Is8WsgaoAcAes8Ux1iKXd"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"三、頁(yè)面排版的4大利器","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnA6YyoGGS88WiYddezhIPee"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"想要實(shí)現(xiàn)以上4項(xiàng)排版原則,則需要利用以下4種輔助工具來(lái)操作。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnyOEMyiU86aWqqM9eXvkbQb"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"1、對(duì)齊。","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"PPT為用戶提供了8種對(duì)齊方式。通過(guò)使用這些對(duì)齊方式,用戶可以快速完成頁(yè)面的布局,提高PPT排版效率,對(duì)齊的操作方法如下::","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnUieC8GQ4Yukq2xM8re041f"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步驟1:選擇需對(duì)齊的元素,這里選擇文本,切換至“繪圖工具-格式”選項(xiàng)卡,單擊“對(duì)齊”下拉按鈕,從列表中選擇“垂直居中”選項(xiàng)。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcncAA8ggsQsymke8f5hXaXae"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":1032,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"PPT版式設(shè)計(jì)原則","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/24cde981191f483cb1b67d9f3a30fb36","width":1917},"text":"","id":"doxcnGsweeiw64WSW6xRmwH34me"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步驟2:此時(shí)可以看到,選中的文本已經(jīng)顯示為垂直居中。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnEsc0yAoQWWg4gJ2hI9CSYg"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":767,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"PPT版式設(shè)計(jì)原則","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/34296935d40d4d1ca9abb1fe87f13128","width":1375},"text":"","id":"doxcnw6K0oWWys86oOW2Uh6Spth"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步驟3:若在列表中選擇“右對(duì)齊”選項(xiàng),則選中的文本將向右對(duì)齊顯示。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnCocUMImgq4y0WI3r8Lcgkg"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":771,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"PPT版式設(shè)計(jì)原則","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/4307565bd11c4e9d97085a989f3e54e9","width":1377},"text":"","id":"doxcnuUaAcqqQM8uEkDGwR31Syh"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"2、組合。","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"將多個(gè)對(duì)象組合在一起后,可以實(shí)現(xiàn)整體的快速移動(dòng),當(dāng)縮小或放大形狀組合時(shí),組合中的所有形狀的大小會(huì)同時(shí)發(fā)生改變,具體操作方法如下:","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnqeeoKeuuKmS2MXpgPJfeph"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步驟1:選中圖形對(duì)象,單擊鼠標(biāo)右鍵,從彈出的快捷菜單中選擇“組合”選項(xiàng)。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnomsWcMaIg2Ewiyd9nBSWgc"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":1032,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"PPT版式設(shè)計(jì)原則","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/78e6dc30ef924157813982161adfc813","width":1920},"text":"","id":"doxcnY2mYMSMgII6YcfE3gdJtnc"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步驟2:將形狀組合在一起后,按住Shift鍵不放,可以等比例放大或縮小圖形。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnsAww0sqssCag7mEpoXgglF"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"3、窗格。","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"窗格可以通過(guò)單擊“繪圖工具-格式”選項(xiàng)卡中的“選擇窗格”按鈕打開,窗格的作用是調(diào)節(jié)各個(gè)元素的層次,對(duì)此也可以通過(guò)鼠標(biāo)拖動(dòng)來(lái)實(shí)現(xiàn),還可以通過(guò)單擊按鈕實(shí)現(xiàn)。此外,通過(guò)窗格還可以隱藏元素,單擊右側(cè)的眼睛圖標(biāo)即可隱藏。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcniKg20EwYMm6mqfmoiYpQTx"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":1034,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"PPT版式設(shè)計(jì)原則","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/7cdbe3f54c594ba8b087e00311be3e0c","width":1908},"text":"","id":"doxcnC84I88GqiA6Ie417K3v4ze"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"4、網(wǎng)格與參考線。","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"網(wǎng)格和參考線一般用來(lái)定位PPT中的各元素。兩者都是在編輯狀態(tài)下顯示,播放幻燈片時(shí)則會(huì)自動(dòng)隱藏。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnMgws2eq8ImIoIBX3fVDr3c"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"如果需要調(diào)出網(wǎng)格或參考線的話,只需要在“視圖”選項(xiàng)卡中勾選“網(wǎng)格”或“參考線”選項(xiàng)即可。這兩個(gè)選項(xiàng)卡可以同時(shí)勾選,也可以只勾選其中一項(xiàng)。在對(duì)頁(yè)面進(jìn)行排版時(shí),只需勾選“參考線”這一項(xiàng)即可。在勾選參考線后,系統(tǒng)會(huì)在頁(yè)面中心位置分別顯示水平和垂直兩條參考線。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnaGQEKOoS2g88KPftXyvY8E"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":1030,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"PPT版式設(shè)計(jì)原則","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/2f97feedd4944571b1bacafac8212976","width":1920},"text":"","id":"doxcnysUGYUaqYuoceEUcFg0QXc"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"需要添加參考線的話,只需將光標(biāo)放置在參考線上,當(dāng)光標(biāo)變成雙向箭頭時(shí),點(diǎn)擊鼠標(biāo)右鍵,在彈出的快捷菜單中根據(jù)需要選擇“添加垂直參考線”或“添加水平參考線”選項(xiàng)即可。也可以為參考線更換顏色。同樣在參考線上點(diǎn)擊鼠標(biāo)右鍵,在快捷菜單中選擇“顏色”選項(xiàng),并在打開的級(jí)聯(lián)菜單中選擇一種顏色即可。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnWgkew6sEYQKQM1tAQhAQXd"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":1033,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"PPT版式設(shè)計(jì)原則","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/d7c7e6c6322443b390fba867d2b1a1f1","width":1920},"text":"","id":"doxcnWwIQQYMwoA8Gw1HQvt0MQg"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"如果想要?jiǎng)h除參考線,只需在“視圖”選項(xiàng)卡中,取消勾選“參考線”選項(xiàng)即可。也可以在參考線上單擊鼠標(biāo)右鍵,在快捷菜單中選擇“刪除”選項(xiàng),即可刪除多余參考線。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnMgyIoqeYce6qu8pizlTMLc"},{"type":"heading","attrs":{"level":2},"children":[{"type":"text","text":"用好PPT模板","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnUkSG8MI80EUAEFe8wsPDPg"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"如果用戶覺(jué)得自己制作模板比較耗時(shí),則可套用網(wǎng)上下載的模板,或者對(duì)現(xiàn)有模板進(jìn)行修改,符合要求后再使用。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcny0CEEuEYowEuopNOktemZb"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"一、如何挑選模板","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcncgWcAIam0wKgQvOS0pgO1f"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"網(wǎng)上有大量的模板,其中不乏精品,但選擇模板時(shí),一定要挑選合適的模板。這里將介紹挑選模板的3個(gè)原則。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcn28yk0AeqOUUYOW0jvlgRIh"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"1、符合公司形象。","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"如果用戶展示的演示文稿代表整個(gè)公司,那么選擇的模板一定要符合公司的形象。一般會(huì)選擇嚴(yán)肅、大方的模板。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnI2Mqc2MgoCUMq4Sm0Ew1nd"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"2、契合展示主題。","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"選擇模板時(shí)要符合展示的主題,不同的主題對(duì)模板的要求不一樣。例如,如果主題是關(guān)于兒童教育的,就盡量用卡通類的,或者各種手繪風(fēng)格的模板。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnCEOQewmaowAOqE9xwNgCzg"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"3、讓人眼前一亮。","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"用戶制作PPT除了輔助演講外,最重要的是吸引觀眾的注意力,所以制作的PPT要有特色,看起來(lái)讓人賞心悅目,這樣才能讓人眼前一亮。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnm4mwKIyIgMSCkVHMdbM9uf"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"注:可以通過(guò)PPT論壇、共享網(wǎng)站、PPT商店、PPT模板下載網(wǎng)站以及達(dá)人的博客或微博下載需要的PPT模板。需要提醒一點(diǎn)的是,下載模板時(shí)需弄清楚該模板是否可以商用。很多模板都存在版權(quán)問(wèn)題,用戶私下交流沒(méi)有關(guān)系,一旦涉及商用,就需繳納一定的版權(quán)費(fèi)了。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnmuIa42Gk64GGQRHvUS18zh"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"二、對(duì)模板進(jìn)行微調(diào)","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcn2g6wY8gmyCwWcrsUe7t0Mc"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"一般情況下,模板下載完以后,都需要對(duì)其調(diào)整,畢竟沒(méi)有百分之百合適的模板。當(dāng)用戶需要對(duì)模板進(jìn)行調(diào)整時(shí),可以分3步操作:刪除、改變和添加。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcn8EmK8gEmOSE2QtckisBSdb"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"1、刪除多余頁(yè)面或元素。","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"刪除模板中一些多余的頁(yè)面,因?yàn)橛行╉?yè)面只是版面設(shè)計(jì)不同,而內(nèi)容是相同的,像這些頁(yè)面就需要?jiǎng)h除。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnAaGwwo0gM6ocvmtRBCg6Ns"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"2、改變。","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"可以改變幻燈片的大小、背景圖、配色、字體和版式設(shè)計(jì)等。首先,可以修改以下幻燈片的版式設(shè)計(jì)。其次,可以將標(biāo)題幻燈片中的文字進(jìn)行修改,例如修改其文字內(nèi)容、字體或字號(hào)等。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnq4K0ECyUgYgciGeHBNw2Rh"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"3、添加。","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"如果現(xiàn)有的版式不能完全滿足需求,則可以另外添加一頁(yè)版式。用戶只需根據(jù)自己的需求簡(jiǎn)單調(diào)整即可。這樣做出來(lái)的PPT既快又好。","id":""},{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"想高效制作PPT,使用模板是最佳的選擇。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcncKsG4GoUo4cqmGZUql3Pee"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"三、認(rèn)識(shí)幻燈片的母版","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnAyOeGquuCukOa0NYd2QVLc"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"使用母版最大的好處在于,它可以快速統(tǒng)一幻燈片的風(fēng)格,例如文字、圖片、背景等。下面將詳細(xì)介紹母版的結(jié)構(gòu)和類型。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnmC4g2oGYUqiu89RtZeRCve"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步驟1:打開演示文稿,切換至“視圖”選項(xiàng)卡,單擊“幻燈片母版”按鈕。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnSwieEIwKoAiWueHiH0nA1g"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":1030,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"用好PPT模板","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/604df3b3357048cab968b45728ff523e","width":1920},"text":"","id":"doxcnwiuqUCQYMcSiUHBpyn4V4f"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步驟2:進(jìn)入母版視圖后,在左側(cè)可以看到一組默認(rèn)的母版結(jié)構(gòu)。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcn4Aq4uOY0U4cIw0VPZoSxJC"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":1030,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"用好PPT模板","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/940212a280e64e049a1b7951c3d36819","width":1915},"text":"","id":"doxcnSsiM8cacyMceERe1rWNHaf"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步驟3:Office主題。該頁(yè)位于母版視圖的首位,也稱之為母版頁(yè)。在這一頁(yè)中添加的內(nèi)容會(huì)出現(xiàn)在以下所有版式頁(yè)中。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnUIiE8CC0EekEeGnNRa2Xxb"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"注:母版視圖是由母版頁(yè)和版式頁(yè)這兩個(gè)部分組成的。母版頁(yè)僅為第1張幻燈片,除此之外,所有的幻燈片都稱為版式頁(yè)。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnySauWIQs8oUeAWEt7U7zkw"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":1033,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"用好PPT模板","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/6054b0f5db8046789cd9bab77403e608","width":1917},"text":"","id":"doxcniYaSYY6AQGwMkNVrw5K9je"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步驟4:標(biāo)題幻燈片。可用于幻燈片的封面、封底設(shè)計(jì)。與母版頁(yè)不同時(shí),需要勾選隱藏背景圖形復(fù)選框。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnEAQCSkGAYAkOCwed5fD4Se"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":1029,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"用好PPT模板","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/274cad5c7269496e976dfb4204161042","width":1920},"text":"","id":"doxcnOmyuguUSa6UOEVXU2v2wmc"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步驟5:標(biāo)題和內(nèi)容。由標(biāo)題框架和內(nèi)容框架部分組成。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcncKo6cueueGA24O75ftouuc"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":1034,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"用好PPT模板","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/c17d02e2157a4eb8b7508b5c8645c133","width":1920},"text":"","id":"doxcngWUIyqCEq0m8Xl5eeBGeA8"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步驟6:此外,還有節(jié)標(biāo)題、兩欄內(nèi)容、比較、僅標(biāo)題、空白、內(nèi)容與標(biāo)題版式等。這些版式都可以根據(jù)設(shè)計(jì)需要重新調(diào)整。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnwc0OgMm2EWyOchcnkfEUrb"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"四、修改幻燈片的母版","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcn2qIIEUqQisQgKcsdnwa9vg"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"用戶可以在幻燈片母版中修改字體和版式,使幻燈片形成統(tǒng)一的風(fēng)格。","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"具體操作步驟介紹如下:","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnoscgYY2QIC2MGgGQtQzobc"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步驟1:打開演示文稿,切換至“視圖”選項(xiàng)卡,單擊“幻燈片母版”按鈕。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnueAA6EWsQMGm0kslF477Dg"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步驟2:進(jìn)入母版視圖模式,然后選擇Office主題母版,并選中其中的標(biāo)題占位符。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnIiCoYEASg2K62Rqs3AFzDd"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步驟3:切換至“開始”選項(xiàng)卡,單擊“字體”下拉按鈕,從列表中選擇“漢儀行楷簡(jiǎn)”選項(xiàng)。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnmYEwmCqoyuoyGCB1Mq4iXb"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步驟4:?jiǎn)螕簟白痔?hào)”下拉按鈕,從列表中選擇“40”。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcneyuI0eCYKsysZhXeiVpbLn"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步驟5:按照同樣的方法,設(shè)置文本占位符中的字體、字號(hào)。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnuaYWs4quqe0IScEUW4gWLd"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步驟6:切換至“幻燈片母版”選項(xiàng)卡,單擊“背景樣式”下拉按鈕,從列表中選擇“設(shè)置背景格式”選項(xiàng)。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnoaaMM80KYKguye2QfHmbie"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步驟7:打開“設(shè)置背景格式”窗格,切換至“填充”選項(xiàng)卡,在“填充”組中選中“圖片或紋理填充”單選按鈕,并單擊“文件”按鈕。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnKMsYgWg0W8uAuavhQ52Hof"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步驟8:打開“插入圖片”對(duì)話框,從中選擇背景圖片后單擊“插入”按鈕。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcn6uWqUqK4w4wKTXOx6A3TFc"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步驟9:關(guān)閉窗格,切換至“插入”選項(xiàng)卡,單擊“圖片”按鈕。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcn8WQOSciykeA8MNoU0MkBLc"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步驟10:打開“插入圖片”對(duì)話框,選擇圖片后單擊“插入”按鈕。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnMG4Eo6Yki8GW65CIHdIlgc"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步驟11:將圖片插入到母版中,調(diào)整圖片的大小,將其移至頁(yè)面合適位置。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnKkUaSGOUsuYsiKwWHUdH7e"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步驟12:按照同樣的方法,插入另外—張圖片,然后將其移至合適位置。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcngAACmq4mKMUawJS425Rxzg"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步驟13:選中標(biāo)題幻燈片,在“背景”選項(xiàng)組中勾選“隱藏背景圖形”復(fù)選框。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnayWIU62aYYqAoJG9FBwl4c"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步驟14:隱藏圖形后,為其填充背景圖片。在“插入”選項(xiàng)卡中單擊“圖片”按鈕。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcn6IQgwc0mMEauUPHKhhHSzf"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步驟15:打開“插入圖片”對(duì)話框,選擇圖片后單擊“插入”按鈕。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnUuM84u6oYkGsKkSK5sfTdh"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步驟16:插入圖片后調(diào)整圖片的大小,并將其移至頁(yè)面合適位置。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnas0iK4SiW8o86PWZl5M6Tc"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步驟17:?jiǎn)螕簟盎脽羝赴妗边x項(xiàng)卡中的“關(guān)閉母版視圖”按鈕,查看設(shè)置的效果。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnIkugGWSEGi0GSqzKsvpLog"},{"type":"heading","attrs":{"level":2},"children":[{"type":"text","text":"用好的配色裝扮PPT","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnEqYo82kuq8mU2TJwc9aJYc"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"PPT中的顏色很重要,一個(gè)頁(yè)面色彩靚麗且配色舒適的PPT很容易就能抓往觀眾的眼球。當(dāng)然也不能胡亂的運(yùn)用色彩,下面將介紹關(guān)于配色方面的知識(shí),為設(shè)計(jì)PPT的版式打好基礎(chǔ)。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcn8CqgCEoqiwCEuSvWiFd4xe"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"一、幾種安全配色模式","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnEyWoWy4giGIWIZ9i1FAMEh"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"1、灰底單色搭配。","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"使用灰色作為背景色,和其他單一顏色進(jìn)行搭配。灰色可以營(yíng)造出精致、含蓄的氛圍。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnEU4QuA2kW6mkgDvP3Jk9Pc"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":770,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"用好的配色裝扮PPT","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/57e5c80fd2bd498abf46bf8f34992cc4","width":1372},"text":"","id":"doxcnGEqUcOueawIIq6ZTTlZHTh"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"2、白底單色搭配。","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"白色是百搭色,使用白色作為背景色,可以和任意顏色進(jìn)行搭配。白色給人一種清爽、干凈的感覺(jué)。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnQ0qCcUuGuMcOecXyNDlLcc"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":723,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"用好的配色裝扮PPT","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/db9141ca5bc94a128d56fef95d565f6b","width":1288},"text":"","id":"doxcnUmKy4eagAm8eczT80P3FIc"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"3、同色系明暗搭配。","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"嘗試使用同一種色相、不同明度的顏色進(jìn)行搭配。這種方法比較簡(jiǎn)單和安全。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnWwmisUU680wMUZOHBnDc0d"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":776,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"用好的配色裝扮PPT","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/390bfd836f0546f28ac11a14d369e0c6","width":1366},"text":"","id":"doxcnyEqIy4woas0qG6RcuARVGe"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"4、只用單一背景色。","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"有時(shí)使用單一的背景色加上幾個(gè)關(guān)鍵字或圖片,也能起到很好的效果。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnk4W4YYCeaW00UPx0ARv8Ed"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":777,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"用好的配色裝扮PPT","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/40c2014f762a412aa29d5a454302a47c","width":1379},"text":"","id":"doxcnSQw4WU0iCysOyUBirnj1me"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"二、取色器的使用秘訣","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnsA62iawIe6IkEnXugdhx5e"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"使用取色器可以將其他PPT中的配色提取并運(yùn)用到自己的PPT中,也可以從圖片中快速提取出需要的顏色。下面將為大家介紹具體的操作方法:","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcn6u2CSEYWqkaYasxsTkGjLd"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步驟1:選中需要填充顏色的圖形,切換至“繪圖工具-格式”選項(xiàng)卡,單擊“形狀填充”下拉按鈕,從列表中選擇“取色器”選項(xiàng)。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcn64GUSAEwsSKO9KaYXeECG9"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":1026,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"用好的配色裝扮PPT","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/8eb0d616722e45d38d76b00f38eaed68","width":1919},"text":"","id":"doxcnkoW2Amw6eM4wc9iXrySUBf"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步驟2:此時(shí),鼠標(biāo)光標(biāo)變?yōu)槲苄螤睿瑢⑺苿?dòng)到想要填充的色塊上,在吸管右側(cè)會(huì)顯示該色塊的色值。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcne2kS4WAgKoE4ALiY6lBqmf"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步驟3:確認(rèn)后單擊鼠標(biāo)左鍵,即可將選取的顏色快速填充到圖形中。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcneUOkGemUgOwY2t4kg8QPZg"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"注:","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"在電腦系統(tǒng)中,R、G、B分別代表著紅色、綠色和藍(lán)色,這3種顏色的值均用0-255的整數(shù)來(lái)表示。例如,純紅色的色值為(255,0,0),純綠色的色值為(0.255,0),而純藍(lán)色的色值為(0.,0.255)。用戶只要在“顏色”對(duì)話框的“顏色模式”選項(xiàng)組下設(shè)置這些色值參數(shù)即可,在默認(rèn)情況下“顏色模式”為“RGB“。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnqIk88ggSqm6iYVQ7eFXfZb"},{"type":"heading","attrs":{"level":2},"children":[{"type":"text","text":"學(xué)會(huì)運(yùn)用PPT主題","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcncwwYSamaAKgqkF7NnmwYKh"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"前面介紹了創(chuàng)建模板演示文稿,其實(shí)使用主題創(chuàng)建演示文稿也是一種不錯(cuò)的選擇,這樣可以免去用戶自己設(shè)計(jì)主題的麻煩。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnccsuUw48CKoMeQTOll675b"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"一、使用主題創(chuàng)建PPT","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnqMWa8eCMAa647duzuSEYkn"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"使用主題創(chuàng)建演示文稿的方法和創(chuàng)建模板演示文稿相似,具體的操作步驟如下:","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnioSKm4A0yUWu2jFuppUJvf"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步驟1:?jiǎn)?dòng)PowerPoint,在打開界面的右側(cè)單擊“主題”按鈕。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnim66UuAKYkCaklhW9Fb5hd"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步驟2:在搜索到的主題中選擇合適的選項(xiàng)。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnk2I4sIK4OKKQucg2CKgQLe"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步驟3:?jiǎn)螕粼撨x項(xiàng),將彈出一個(gè)窗格,然后直接單擊“創(chuàng)建”按鈕。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnQy2icEKso6aaEjPAu5nN1f"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步驟4:系統(tǒng)開始下載該主題演示文稿,下載完成后會(huì)自動(dòng)打開演示文稿。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnAgMscIOI026aIp3cxC0XOb"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"二、修改主題樣式","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcne2q6OkWYMOEOekoG9Ra1ae"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"如果對(duì)默認(rèn)的主題樣式不滿意,可以對(duì)主題的顏色、字體、背景等進(jìn)行修改,下面介紹具體的操作方法:","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcn2E2EKQgk2qCmIBvfNcFmBc"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步驟1:修改主題顏色。切換至“設(shè)計(jì)”選項(xiàng)卡,單擊“變體”選項(xiàng)組中的“其他”按鈕,從列表中選擇“顏色”選項(xiàng),并從其級(jí)聯(lián)菜單中選擇合適的顏色。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnamgOKmwEUCqi80MFxTVgCQ"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步驟2:修改主題字體。單擊“變體”選項(xiàng)組中的“其他”按鈕,從列表中選擇“字體”選項(xiàng),并從其級(jí)聯(lián)菜單中選擇合適的字體。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnk2G40gOiUo84cbk1IcCgme"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步驟3:修改主題背景樣式。單擊“變體”選項(xiàng)組中的“其他”按鈕,從列表中選擇“背景樣式”選項(xiàng),并從其級(jí)聯(lián)菜單中選擇“設(shè)置背景格式”選項(xiàng)。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnCeMwMMysMcq0oRXEfUgxBc"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步驟4:修改主題背景樣式。單擊“變體”選項(xiàng)組中的“其他”按鈕,從列表中選擇“背景樣式”選項(xiàng),并從其級(jí)聯(lián)菜單中選擇“設(shè)置背景格式”選項(xiàng)。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnosskEqusGAcQmKRhkriybe"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步驟5:在“設(shè)置背景格式”窗格中單擊“應(yīng)用到全部”按鈕。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnawIGmgiOiKe0odymBHMFFe"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步驟6:?jiǎn)螕簟瓣P(guān)閉”按鈕,關(guān)閉窗格,查看修改主題背景樣式的效果。(注:可以在“設(shè)計(jì)”選項(xiàng)卡中單擊“主題”選項(xiàng)組中的“其他”按鈕,從列表中可以直接更改當(dāng)前演示文稿的主題。)","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnUyIS4W24kukKsCAkC5aZsb"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"主題模板與模板的區(qū)別:主題模板可以統(tǒng)一更改顏色、背景,而模板則不可以。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnUI20U6eEwaaMSshCvby9nc"},{"type":"heading","attrs":{"level":1},"children":[{"type":"text","text":"字體搭配","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnQ8aEEKwq0ke8nxqygk8dMQ"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"制作演示文稿的目的是為了展示內(nèi)容,傳達(dá)觀點(diǎn),所以文本是演示文稿中不可或缺的,并且在幻燈片中輸入文本后還要對(duì)其進(jìn)行各種設(shè)置。本節(jié)將對(duì)文字的選擇、文本的輸入、文本的編輯、文本段落的設(shè)置等操作進(jìn)行全面介紹。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnKm66KoeUuCesOwns35jv9f"},{"type":"heading","attrs":{"level":2},"children":[{"type":"text","text":"文字的選擇有講究","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcn4WqIY88UOg2Ym2SbTF8kWb"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"字體是演示文稿中必不可少的一個(gè)元素,要想制作出優(yōu)秀的演示文稿,選擇一種合適的字體很重要。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnCswUKSSKY8us6Te374ubFb"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"一、選擇合適的字體","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnQIkmC0qwsAq6iiAMJFh1Ce"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"一般用戶會(huì)使用PPT中默認(rèn)的字體,這樣制作出來(lái)的PPT看起來(lái)千篇一律。其實(shí)選擇一種合適的字體,會(huì)起到不—樣的效果,用戶可以根據(jù)不同場(chǎng)合使用不同的字體。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcneiGuIssQgwkqoz5HpbP2Vc"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"1、普通字體。","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"PPT中用到的絕大多數(shù)字體都可歸為普通字體。例如,微軟雅黑、黑體、華文行楷、漢儀系列等,目前大多數(shù)的PPT都經(jīng)常使用這類字體。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcn4UmAuUWy8Qoq6zmChEZjKc"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"2、鋼筆字體。","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"在PPT中使用鋼筆字體,例如方正硬筆行書簡(jiǎn)體、方正硬筆楷書簡(jiǎn)體等,可以使PPT充滿文藝感。這類字體比較適合教育、書籍、文化等領(lǐng)域相關(guān)主題內(nèi)容。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnSUoy8oe02UsqorpIkcLjnF"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"3、書法字體。","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"書法字體很常見(jiàn),例如日本青柳衡山毛筆字體、段寧毛筆行書、葉根友系列字體等,這類字體適合中國(guó)風(fēng)、水墨風(fēng)的PPT。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnAkYaOos8mwkGyKQDQ1Vlob"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"4、卡通字體。","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"卡通字體在視覺(jué)上非常可愛(ài),例如華康娃娃體、方正卡通簡(jiǎn)體、方正胖頭魚簡(jiǎn)體、漢儀樂(lè)窯體等,這類字體適合兒童教學(xué)課件或與兒童相關(guān)的主題。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcn2EA0yCcaQMqUZ0hBYifBft"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"5、英文字體。","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"前面幾種類型均為中文字體,但在制作PPT時(shí)還會(huì)用到英文,那英文字體該怎么選呢?這里將推薦幾款常用英文字體,供用戶參考。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnOoKs66cQgOKqQD2aDaSYmp"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"(1)TimesNewRoman。該字體是系統(tǒng)自帶的英文字體,適合歷史文化類PPT。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcn6EigwEkeQqUAeT3dgxA7ab"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"(2)Tahoma。該字體也是系統(tǒng)自帶的字體,給人一種親切感,在一定程度上可以調(diào)節(jié)現(xiàn)場(chǎng)氛圍。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcncIEm0m0YK06IkxHYC5GoDg"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"(3)SegoeUILight。該字體比較纖細(xì),使用該字體可以使整個(gè)PPT看起來(lái)清新自然。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnyA0U6iQMAa2gYNov38uHmb"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"(4)PalaceScriptMT。該字體是裝飾性很強(qiáng)的手寫體,一般用于文藝、請(qǐng)?zhí)⒐?jié)日等主題。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnO6UOEkkw448GayQVPM1oCc"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"提示:在一張幻燈片中,如果中英文同時(shí)存在,那么英文字體就要根據(jù)中文字體來(lái)調(diào)整,也就是說(shuō)兩種字體要相互匹配。另外,字體也有版權(quán)如果用戶將下載的字體用于商業(yè)用途,則需要支付版權(quán)費(fèi)。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnASAycsc84CKGawVe0dj26d"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"二、安裝字體的方法","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnoAAyksCMyEmc8TJqFONruf"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"如果用戶在網(wǎng)上下載了幾款字體,想要進(jìn)行安裝,可以按照以下幾種方法進(jìn)行操作:","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcn8kA20cgIqku6AG5OcjWRZp"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"1、復(fù)制和粘貼字體。","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"可以全選需要安裝的字體,然后按Ctrl+C組合鍵進(jìn)行復(fù)制操作,再按照相應(yīng)的路徑(C:iWindowsl)找到“Fonts”文件夾,打開該文件夾,按Ctrl+V組合鍵,將復(fù)制的字體進(jìn)行粘貼即可。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcny4YGYC2Am6uuYJiQxFhopc"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"2、“安裝”字體。","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"首先選擇需要安裝的字體,然后單擊鼠標(biāo)右鍵,從彈出的快捷菜單中選擇“安裝”命令即可安裝。此外,還可以雙擊要安裝的字體文件,在打開的字體對(duì)話框中單擊“安裝”按鈕即可。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnGcsGu4CaaAqC6yTwopmQcg"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"3、使用快捷方式安裝字體。","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"在需要安裝大批量的字體時(shí),為了防止占用系統(tǒng)磁盤空間,影響軟件的運(yùn)行速度,可以使用快捷方式來(lái)安裝字體,具體操作方法如下:","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnU0OSc0GGymOGYRFrK6kgUd"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步驟1:根據(jù)路徑(C:iWindowslFonts)打開“Fonts”文件夾,單擊左側(cè)的“字體設(shè)置”選項(xiàng)按鈕。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcniaGi4a0CyUcm21XACotUXf"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步驟2:在打開的“字體設(shè)置”界面中,勾選“允許使用快捷方式安裝字體(高級(jí))”復(fù)選框,單擊“確定”按鈕,關(guān)閉該界面。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnOccs26souQEqw5jy2lX3rf"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步驟3:打開要安裝的字體文件夾,全選字體,單擊鼠標(biāo)右鍵,從彈出的快捷菜單中選擇“作為快捷方式安裝”選項(xiàng)即可。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcn86UC20Kqog6Gc3lA4XErYg"},{"type":"heading","attrs":{"level":2},"children":[{"type":"text","text":"根據(jù)內(nèi)容輸入文本","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcngaG0oKkcwqkY8N0OuaYbDf"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"制作演示文稿時(shí)需要在其中輸入文本,然后設(shè)置文本的字體、字號(hào)、字符間距、文本的特殊效果等操作。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcng2GUWQYUwsQMo5b2Yr7FRf"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"一、輸入文本。","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"想要在幻燈片中輸入文本,則需要占位符和文本框做載體。介紹兩種常見(jiàn)的文本輸入方法:","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnkSwCic0WuCGoW4iV0aphpe"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"1、在占位符中輸入文本。","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"幻燈片中的占位符由幻燈片的版式?jīng)Q定,用戶可以直接在占位符中輸入文本,具體的操作步驟如下:","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnwOUYkqCSwkAeCyb0ZWheTc"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步驟1:打開演示文稿,將光標(biāo)定位至需要輸入文本的占位符中。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnYsWu0m0A0Y2yyk1h1TVCNe"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":1030,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"根據(jù)內(nèi)容輸入文本","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/f5b06831f2884d88baef81baecca9eeb","width":1909},"text":"","id":"doxcn8ewMsKEuUqgQw9ZK7cNYne"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步驟2:選擇合適的輸入法,直接在占位符中輸入文本即可。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnq8qIoEYQcGYQmmPTwdYsqh"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":1032,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"根據(jù)內(nèi)容輸入文本","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/c0dfcd663538428bbda2b22b866e5d8d","width":1916},"text":"","id":"doxcny8sGUaO2K0k6q6XCszZ6zh"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"2、在文本框中輸入文本。","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"需要在幻燈片中添加文本框,然后才能輸入文本,具體操作方法如下:","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnUWuWGaoAi68AjUkZGQR1ko"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步驟1:切換至“插入”選項(xiàng)卡,在“文本”選項(xiàng)組中單擊“文本框”下拉按鈕,在展開的列表中選擇“繪制橫排文本框”選項(xiàng)。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcn2SigUaOw60uS4cvq1KKY2b"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步驟2:鼠標(biāo)光標(biāo)變?yōu)槭中螤睿醋∈髽?biāo)左鍵不放,在頁(yè)面合適位置拖動(dòng)鼠標(biāo)繪制文本框。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnwyM0kC0qaGsYsDkTSjtA6d"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步驟3:繪制好后松開鼠標(biāo),此時(shí)幻燈片中出現(xiàn)一個(gè)虛線框,即為文本框,并且光標(biāo)自動(dòng)定位至文本框中。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnSsGMMMq8I6umQ3ViXmbVFc"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步驟4:在文本框中直接輸入文字即可。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnoi2SiS6ukwiMI9DTmAp6Me"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"二、調(diào)整字體字號(hào)","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcni2EsqqswgkW6oNp0Wnj5kc"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"在幻燈片中輸入文本后,可以對(duì)文本的字體、字號(hào)進(jìn)行設(shè)置,具體的操作方法如下:","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnsi6qYWksYy4MwhEWbpOv4e"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步驟1:調(diào)整字體。選擇需要調(diào)整字體的文本框,然后在“開始”選項(xiàng)卡中單擊“字體”下拉按鈕。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnQwi82ke8oQCKykbDvdnLTg"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步驟2:從展開的下拉列表中選擇“漢儀行楷簡(jiǎn)”選項(xiàng)。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnagWYeaciSsKiWgGwVLUOib"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步驟3:按照同樣的方法設(shè)置其他文本的字體,查看設(shè)置的效果。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcn08WMGWsgwcSQjsDomZ8Ocq"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步驟4:調(diào)整字號(hào)。選擇需要調(diào)整字號(hào)的文本框,在“字號(hào)”文本框中輸入“80”。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnq4MwomasKGOAg7moiDdi5d"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步驟5:按Enter鍵確認(rèn)輸入。按照同樣的方法設(shè)置其他文本的字號(hào)。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcn0UsSo0qWKC2gCwLCYLJdzb"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"提示:","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"可以選擇需要設(shè)置顏色的文本,在“開始”選項(xiàng)卡中單擊“字體顏色”下拉按鈕,從列表中選擇合適的顏色,即可為所選文本設(shè)置顏色。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnWGEqsyoWUyG2cN3QuYI0ig"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"三、應(yīng)用文本特殊效果","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnqigeGKIWAwy0yo5SMWysvf"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"如果用戶想要文本特殊顯示,可以為其設(shè)置加粗、傾斜、陰影、下劃線等效果,下面將介紹具體的操作方法:","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnOKKwkeou4ws2egIDun7sZd"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步驟1:加粗。選擇需要加粗的文本,在“開臺(tái)”選項(xiàng)卡中單擊“加粗”按鈕即可使文本加粗顯示。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnQyey8g02m64UgloNyK9ofh"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步驟2:傾斜。選擇文本,在“開始”選項(xiàng)卡中單擊“傾斜”按鈕,即可將文本變傾斜。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnUiUE86YY868yArCr7CJhNg"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步驟3:陰影。選擇文本,在“開始”選項(xiàng)卡中單擊“文字陰影”按鈕。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnYEAgOo0oCAU0wpWui8giSd"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步驟4:下劃線。選擇文本,在“開始”選項(xiàng)卡中單擊“下劃線”按鈕。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcngIAkIGEwYsY0GoJpIfzEhf"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步驟5:如果用戶想要清除設(shè)置的效果,則可以單擊“清除所有格式”按鈕,可以將所設(shè)置的格式效果清除。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnsMca8M24Ky2YqqOT7pturc"},{"type":"heading","attrs":{"level":2},"children":[{"type":"text","text":"編輯輸入的文本","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnGo2AYc60myAs8mT6q9fxyc"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"在幻燈片中輸入文本后,通常還需要對(duì)其進(jìn)行各種編輯,這時(shí)就會(huì)涉及到對(duì)文本的一些基礎(chǔ)操作,例如選取文本、移動(dòng)與復(fù)制文本、查找和替換等。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcn0KICAeEUey88MPXXpXbLYc"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"一、選取文本","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnYsq4cMKQOgoOMd5Wwmglgu"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"1、選擇連續(xù)的文本。","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"只需要將光標(biāo)定位至需要選擇文本的開始位置,然后按住鼠標(biāo)左鍵不放,拖動(dòng)鼠標(biāo)至需要選擇文本的結(jié)束位置,釋放鼠標(biāo)左鍵即可。此外,用戶也可以將光標(biāo)定位至需要選擇文本的開始位置,然后按住Shift鍵不放,單擊選擇文本的結(jié)束處,即可將開始到結(jié)束處的這段文本內(nèi)容全部選中。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcn8QI8sGieMEsU8ICubyk7wH"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"2、選擇單個(gè)詞語(yǔ)。","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"需要將光標(biāo)定位至某個(gè)詞語(yǔ)的任意位置,然后雙擊鼠標(biāo),即可將該詞語(yǔ)選中。還可以將光標(biāo)定位至詞語(yǔ)的開始位置,然后按住鼠標(biāo)左鍵不放,拖動(dòng)鼠標(biāo)至詞語(yǔ)的結(jié)束位置,釋放鼠標(biāo)左鍵,即可將該詞語(yǔ)選中。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnGsiAAKKq8G6UuUyslQ9l9D"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"3、選擇段落。","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"在選擇段落的任意位置處連續(xù)單擊3次鼠標(biāo)左鍵,即可將該段落選中。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcngQ4KK4G0Waomod6BzZlg4c"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"4、選擇多處不連續(xù)的區(qū)域。","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"在文檔中先使用拖動(dòng)鼠標(biāo)的方法選擇一個(gè)文本,然后按住Ctrl鍵不放,依次選擇其他文本,這樣就可以將多個(gè)不連續(xù)的區(qū)域選中。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcni6wWekq6WoGcURQEXgcY6g"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"5、選擇全部文本。","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"使用快捷鍵全選文本,只需將光標(biāo)定位至文本中任意位置,然后按Ctrl+A組合鍵,即可將文本全部選中。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnWuo0kSIGauyMKSIWS58IKc"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"二、移動(dòng)和復(fù)制文本","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnwKggqOOSsucEumtpibzV0e"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"用戶使用移動(dòng)與復(fù)制命令,可以減少重復(fù)文本的錄入,提高工作效率。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnCAE6uUC2CGy6WTeUiKvch2"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"1、移動(dòng)文本。","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"可以使用“剪切”命令移動(dòng)文本,操作如下:","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnGqKqcAeWk26iue7ZQKGK8f"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步驟1:選中需要移動(dòng)的文本,在“開始”選項(xiàng)卡中單擊“剪切”按鈕。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnGkeMWMWgKqOcqgvtQsupTh"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步驟2:選擇需要粘貼文本的幻燈片,然后在“開始”選項(xiàng)卡中單擊“粘貼”按鈕,文本隨即被移動(dòng)到該幻燈片中。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcn0AiWCOYYAKGaCIaTHsTY3e"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步驟3:選中文本,然后按住鼠標(biāo)左鍵不放,拖動(dòng)鼠標(biāo),即可將其移至幻燈片頁(yè)面合適位置。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnwwEqOIEUuICo8g8ho1BpPb"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"提示:","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"使用快捷鍵Ctrl+X剪切文本,然后使用Ctrl+V粘貼文本,也可以移動(dòng)文本。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcn68eu0sUuEI4iIz8jjteRPd"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"2、復(fù)制文本。","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"復(fù)制文本是將所選內(nèi)容復(fù)制到剪貼板,然后粘貼到其他位置,具體操作方法如下:","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcn0qGA0OeO2gemGmMukpcFSg"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步驟1:選擇需要復(fù)制的文本,然后在“開始”選項(xiàng)卡中單擊“復(fù)制”按鈕。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnieyEqGMqUKm2GukquZYVRh"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步驟2:選擇需要粘貼的幻燈片,單擊“粘貼”按鈕,即可復(fù)制選擇的文本。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcncCSescackqowMlL5l5zXMb"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"提示:","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"用戶也可以選擇需要復(fù)制的文本,按Ctrl+D組合鍵進(jìn)行復(fù)制。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnS2O0MkOSSIgkIjGf6VTGEd"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"三、查找與替換文本","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnIkgecIuAqooOpjKrAyRdvl"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"當(dāng)演示文稿中出現(xiàn)大量的錯(cuò)誤文本時(shí),為了節(jié)省時(shí)間,可以使用查找和替換功能進(jìn)行更改,下面將介紹具體的操作方法:","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnAyEsQuc8yag4KU2CUC0qMd"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"1、查找文本。","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"首先要將錯(cuò)誤的文本查找出來(lái),具體操作方法如下:","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnmI4QUsWYao8gYVmig4ubdb"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步驟1:打開演示文稿,在“開始”選項(xiàng)卡中單擊“編輯”選項(xiàng)組的“查找”按鈕。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnqWYM0I82aGuKmcaDblOEGh"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步驟2:打開“查找”對(duì)話框,在“查找內(nèi)容”文本框中輸入要查找的文本,這里輸入“想要查找的文本內(nèi)容”,然后單擊“查找下一個(gè)”按鈕。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnEGcqos6KEKC0d0mWzzbnro"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步驟3:此時(shí),查找到的文本處于選中狀態(tài),用戶可以確認(rèn)是否屬于錄入錯(cuò)誤。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcn6gYc0wOiQSqCAiH4SQCsus"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步驟4:繼續(xù)單擊“查找下一個(gè)”按鈕,當(dāng)查找到最后一個(gè)文本時(shí),會(huì)彈出提示對(duì)話框,提示用戶已經(jīng)查找到最后一個(gè)匹配項(xiàng)目,單擊“確定”按鈕,關(guān)閉“查找”對(duì)話框即可。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnmCu6YUesCO8US2gLwF3DHh"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"2、替換文本。","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"用戶可以逐一替換錯(cuò)誤的文本,也可以全部替換,具體的操作方法如下:","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnwk02So4sGwcayAxAzs3SWd"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步驟1:在“開始”選項(xiàng)卡中單擊“編輯”選項(xiàng)組的“替換”按鈕。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnWMkGMm0oCYkiUrmlcqULib"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步驟2:打開“替換”對(duì)話框,在“查找內(nèi)容”文本框中輸入要查找的文本,然后在“替換為”文本框中輸入要替換的文本,單擊“查找下一個(gè)”按鈕。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnYg044k0oqqooeyXoATdP7D"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步驟3:系統(tǒng)隨即查找到相匹配的文本,接著單擊“替換”按鈕,","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"即可將文本進(jìn)行替換","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcn4gW4OY0gO8Aqm6SX5O5KCg"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步驟4:","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"如果單擊“全部替換”按鈕,可以一次性將查找到的文本全部替換。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnKUIYmQemoSyYaCyMCcXDVe"},{"type":"heading","attrs":{"level":2},"children":[{"type":"text","text":"設(shè)置文本段落","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcno6QWOYkkwCYIiWcqG08pCd"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"在幻燈片中輸入文本內(nèi)容后需要對(duì)其設(shè)置段落格式,這樣整個(gè)頁(yè)面才能更加美觀,段落格式的設(shè)置包括設(shè)置段落對(duì)齊方式、行及段落間距等。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnQ48KoIog0GsGSMfdW3ILcm"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"一、設(shè)置段落對(duì)齊方式","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnsKayCAS2GUY2qauQN8GJNh"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"段落對(duì)齊方式是指段落對(duì)齊到文本框的方式,包括水平對(duì)齊和垂直對(duì)齊。下面將介紹如何設(shè)置段落的水平對(duì)齊方式。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcn4OEO88GosaaQ8jLpTrfXrf"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步驟1:選中需要設(shè)置對(duì)齊方式的文本,在“開始”選項(xiàng)卡中單擊“居中”按鈕。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnyCQAscSmeIaycHN415gegc"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":1027,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"設(shè)置文本段落","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/ba0b15638bfb475f85520b25266f2f67","width":1920},"text":"","id":"doxcnE6Cs4ukcMquIa7cCMYS2IX"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步驟2:此外,用戶還可以在“開始”選項(xiàng)卡中單擊“對(duì)齊文本”下拉按鈕,從列表中選擇所需的垂直對(duì)齊方式。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnU2cA4y6Q8UKoMFChchT5xf"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":1033,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"設(shè)置文本段落","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/d4536daa5f4a4f1a8062c210ce8e1745","width":1920},"text":"","id":"doxcnaG4igOyiYoqwvZTLVg3AKs"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"二、設(shè)置行間距及段落間距","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnuOGyGAaek0GEcvcaFbWsXG"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"如果一個(gè)文本框中包含多個(gè)行和段落,為其置合適的行和段落間距,可以使整個(gè)幻燈片頁(yè)看起來(lái)更加舒適、美觀,下面將介紹如何設(shè)置子及段落間距。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnGk6MGMQiE8okgDThUa9eDd"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"1、設(shè)置行距。","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"行距是指每一行文字之間的距離,設(shè)置行距的操作方法如下:","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnosMqUc8ySycmkFt6E5iCzd"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步驟1:選中要設(shè)置行距的文本,在“開始”選頁(yè)卡中單擊“行距”下拉按鈕。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnaKwWW4SkQCUUSKTW6CJIZd"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":1027,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"設(shè)置文本段落","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/faa0d6809f7744dda6fb47669c525d49","width":1920},"text":"","id":"doxcn8kooSiU2wYI26mBgaRj5Vf"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步驟2:對(duì)選中的文本各行之間的間距進(jìn)行相應(yīng)的調(diào)整。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnmgSYoe2kKCAomweOhgy6og"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"2、設(shè)置段落間距。","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"段落間距是指段落與段落之間的距離,可以設(shè)置段前和段后的距離,具體操作方法如下:","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnWWqoAyiWOiCkag1NbuicTg"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步驟1:選擇需要設(shè)置段落間距的文本,在“開始”選項(xiàng)卡中單擊“段落”選項(xiàng)組的對(duì)話框啟動(dòng)器按鈕。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcn04K0S8SgwiewCCTm38h5Od"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":1034,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"設(shè)置文本段落","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/3f46749bc6704c649be6cdc97fd4c9c6","width":1919},"text":"","id":"doxcnyQEuUa0i0GQsEnxRQoCcvd"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步驟2:打開“段落”對(duì)話框,在“縮進(jìn)和間距”選項(xiàng)卡中設(shè)置“段前”、“段后”間距,設(shè)置完成后單擊“確定”按鈕。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnSQgSaaykIqQ6aOaGPMLmnf"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":1034,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"設(shè)置文本段落","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/ddbffb866d76442f8fdec353eb611d9c","width":1920},"text":"","id":"doxcnKmucGO2kWga2CgEqPf6bOe"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"三、添加項(xiàng)目符號(hào)及編號(hào)","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnIGC2Y4wMU8cyonnLppPobg"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"為文本添加項(xiàng)目符號(hào)或編號(hào)可使文本內(nèi)容更有條理性,下面講解如何添加項(xiàng)目符號(hào)及編號(hào)。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnOSYCQoqi84EiGMZOQe4vnh"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步驟1:添加項(xiàng)目符號(hào)。選中需要添加項(xiàng)目符號(hào)的文本,在“開始”選項(xiàng)卡中單擊“項(xiàng)目符號(hào)”下拉按鈕,從列表中選擇合適的項(xiàng)目符號(hào),這里選擇“帶填充效果的鉆石形項(xiàng)目符號(hào)”選項(xiàng)。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnQ4SSgE0UiYEuWQrybrCFZf"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":1029,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"設(shè)置文本段落","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/5cf7d98f35f64a2baebedd9b07181ce8","width":1915},"text":"","id":"doxcnScKCkiIWYaOIgJorkfOBHb"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步驟2:可以看到選中的文本隨即被添加了項(xiàng)目符號(hào)。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnQIeuS8e8S8QckDyM6ul8Re"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":829,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"設(shè)置文本段落","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/efd366487f874621aa28e279481de471","width":1475},"text":"","id":"doxcnQokkwoEQc8CAy0cTCZoVIg"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"四、設(shè)置文本分欄","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcn2wU40W402WsmAxvJAGtiXb"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步驟1:選擇需要分欄的文本,在“開始”選項(xiàng)卡中單擊“添加或刪除欄”下拉按鈕。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcn4EIkeQ00oU6WMXp2DWNMlg"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":1027,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"設(shè)置文本段落","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/1606f005db6f4811bac2b5b5ef1d6121","width":1906},"text":"","id":"doxcnkykSCUaoAuY4IVbbGRgOMf"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步驟2:從展開的列表中選擇“更多欄”選項(xiàng)。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnG2CqQqWaiuoamAwCDZzPBh"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":1030,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"設(shè)置文本段落","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/3cb73103ca9f43f294b3e2121331c65a","width":1920},"text":"","id":"doxcny4QsG6i6MsUg8KoJtlKEGc"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步驟3:打開“欄”對(duì)話框,在“數(shù)量”微調(diào)框中輸入數(shù)值“3”,在“間距”微調(diào)框中輸入數(shù)值“0.5”,設(shè)置完成后單擊“確定”按鈕。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnocgw6kEyQUwaOqwMbMDpbb"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":1033,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"設(shè)置文本段落","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/481aac1988094555a242e2a2ad7a13ef","width":1920},"text":"","id":"doxcn2uIiqUcge8aCwvZ3HGiBhh"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步驟4:文本隨即被分成3欄,并按照設(shè)置調(diào)整了各欄之間的間距。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnSCSCeYSSA6ouq6lRIEOgPh"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":1033,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"設(shè)置文本段落","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/4d09d959ee564f5b87959833342e66b8","width":1920},"text":"","id":"doxcnEWwgaUksak2OsRLE533Qqh"},{"type":"heading","attrs":{"level":2},"children":[{"type":"text","text":"藝術(shù)字的妙用","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcno8coEAKGUYoUElMCdOLy6f"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"在制作幻燈片時(shí)使用藝術(shù)字可以快速抓住觀眾的眼球,而且外觀多變的藝術(shù)字還能為幻燈片增加活潑生動(dòng)的氣息。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnOaWCEsgCyqC8aLqXhQMHkb"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"步驟1:","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"打開演示文稿,切換至“插入”選項(xiàng)卡,單擊“文本”選項(xiàng)組中的","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"“藝術(shù)字”下拉按鈕","id":""},{"type":"text","text":",從列表中選擇合適的藝術(shù)字效果。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnWeiosogamqkgkl5XXgaA9g"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"步驟2:","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"幻燈片中隨即插入一個(gè)相應(yīng)的藝術(shù)字文本框,接著在文本框中直接輸入內(nèi)容即可。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnIwscMwiWUS0ey86RZ9OYPc"},{"type":"heading","attrs":{"level":2},"children":[{"type":"text","text":"美化文本","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnWKYGsGAaCAmK0eT6oJrfle"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"除了利用藝術(shù)字功能來(lái)美化文本外,還可以利用文本自帶的美化功能,例如設(shè)置三維旋轉(zhuǎn)文本、設(shè)置路徑文本等,制作出不一樣的文字效果。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnEKoqmG0OWwasQbmwuusysf"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"一、設(shè)置三維旋轉(zhuǎn)文本。","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"在PPT中利用“三維旋轉(zhuǎn)”功能可以","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"制作透視字體效果","id":""},{"type":"text","text":",具體操作方法如下:","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcn0gWwsQ60iuSwsXW1QE8tWd"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步驟1:選擇幻燈片,切換至“插入”選項(xiàng)卡,擊“文本”選項(xiàng)組的“文本框”下拉按鈕,從表中選擇“豎排文本框”選項(xiàng)。繪制一個(gè)豎排文本框,并在其中輸入文本內(nèi)容。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnaCWesUkiquSeauVOZgCayc"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步驟2:選中文本。在“開始”選項(xiàng)卡中將“字體”設(shè)置為“方正隸書簡(jiǎn)體”,將“字號(hào)”設(shè)置為“96”,將“字體顏色”設(shè)置為“白色”。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcn2k2msyESekgqQt9W3lpU5e"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步驟3:選中文本框,單擊鼠標(biāo)右鍵,從彈出的快捷菜單中選擇“設(shè)置形狀格式”命令。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcn4ASUwYa480268BWBbkUuae"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步驟4:打開“設(shè)置形狀格式”窗格,切換至“效果”選項(xiàng)卡。在“三維旋轉(zhuǎn)”選項(xiàng)組中設(shè)置“X旋轉(zhuǎn)”“Y旋轉(zhuǎn)”和“Z旋轉(zhuǎn)”。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnIks0qkCoKQO0ugkcSobBKg"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步驟5:設(shè)置完成后關(guān)閉窗格。選中文本框,切換至“繪圖工具-格式”選項(xiàng)卡,單擊“藝術(shù)字樣式”選項(xiàng)組的對(duì)話框啟動(dòng)器按鈕。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnkMW88oMuiA8AK8h9p1CPid"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步驟6:打開“設(shè)置形狀格式”窗格,切換至“文本填充與輪廓”選項(xiàng)卡,在“文本填充”選項(xiàng)組中調(diào)整“透明度”。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnYII40uG2s2siGCZkkKqRlb"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步驟7:調(diào)整好后關(guān)閉窗格,然后復(fù)制該文本框,并修改文本框的文字內(nèi)容,同時(shí)調(diào)整該文本的字號(hào)。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnEY6ie0IWgOymOOsBILIJXb"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步驟8:選中復(fù)制的文本框,打開“設(shè)置形狀格式”窗格。在“效果”選項(xiàng)卡中設(shè)置“三維旋轉(zhuǎn)”的“X旋轉(zhuǎn)”“Y旋轉(zhuǎn)”和“Z旋轉(zhuǎn)”。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnac224Ki02YEO0YBxNV0cZb"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步驟9:設(shè)置完成后關(guān)閉窗格,查看制作透視字體的效果。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnMQyc2Yec2QuqGoDN5KlJwg"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"提示:由于透視角度的不同,所以文字位置一旦變化.就需要重新調(diào)整參數(shù)。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnuY0OOsGoeUA82h24qlVjyg"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"二、設(shè)置路徑文本","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnYwA2MqGeQS0Y8ZWCMjJK7d"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"用戶可以通過(guò)“文字效果”功能來(lái)制作拱形字體,具體操作方法如下:","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcns6ksW2cGcIEcMZ6nifzuJe"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步驟1:繪制橫排文本框并輸入文本。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnGAGc4AOi6emKATYLr3yvve"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步驟2:選擇文本,在“開始”選項(xiàng)卡中將“字體”設(shè)置為“漢儀橄欖體簡(jiǎn)”,將“字號(hào)”設(shè)置為“44”,將“字體顏色”設(shè)置為“深綠色”。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcn0IcCw84ykQOeYj4mCt6Lug"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步驟3:切換至“繪圖工具-格式”選項(xiàng)卡,單擊“文字效果”下拉按鈕。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnaww4OMcOck6yCyKUu6ezMb"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步驟4:從展開的列表中選擇“轉(zhuǎn)換”選項(xiàng),并從其級(jí)聯(lián)菜單中選擇“拱形”效果。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnkuWmeew8wI0msrQh0ngSog"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步驟5:文字已變形。為了能夠與圖中地球輪廓相一致,則需對(duì)它進(jìn)行調(diào)整。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnSq2yikwMAuo68Rguq31Xzf"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步驟6:選中文字,將其移至合適的位置后,將光標(biāo)放在文本框下方的中點(diǎn)上,此時(shí)光標(biāo)變?yōu)殡p向箭頭。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcn02oSoY4kOcQoWegH1Tnr4B"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步驟7:按住鼠標(biāo)左鍵不放,向下拖動(dòng)鼠標(biāo)至合適位置,調(diào)整文字的彎曲度。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnskOi6EuwuWqsudVi4TmhXl"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步驟8:調(diào)整文字的方向,將光標(biāo)移動(dòng)至文字起始處的路徑圓點(diǎn)(橙色的圓點(diǎn))位置,按住鼠標(biāo)左鍵不放,拖動(dòng)該控制點(diǎn)至合適位置,可調(diào)整文字路徑。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnK4Cg46OKM4eaeIGQtxVvPd"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步驟9:對(duì)路徑進(jìn)行反復(fù)調(diào)整后,查看效果。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnK0EWKwiY2sqWqKi89YO63b"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步驟10:改變“心”和“家”文字的“字號(hào)”和“顏色”。查看制作拱形文字的效果。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnKS8KWwY8IYI6mISj9W79bf"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"提示:將路徑圓點(diǎn)向下拖動(dòng)時(shí),文字會(huì)隨著路徑適當(dāng)放大;相反,將路徑圓點(diǎn)向上拖動(dòng)時(shí),文字會(huì)隨之縮小。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcn8KAackM62y6sGQZ3zCzVZf"},{"type":"heading","attrs":{"level":1},"children":[{"type":"text","text":"圖片制作攻略","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnA6AE6kkYqCGsqYFJM6eRBg"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"PPT中如果只有文字,則會(huì)顯得枯燥乏味。而使用圖文結(jié)合的模式更能吸引觀眾的注意力,所以圖片在幻燈片中起著重要的作用。選擇一張好的圖片,會(huì)使PPT更加出彩。本章將對(duì)圖片的選擇、插入和編輯操作進(jìn)行全面介紹。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnMeeIYuOgWqewiGeuThhVGd"},{"type":"heading","attrs":{"level":2},"children":[{"type":"text","text":"圖片選擇方法","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnMSIMIScyq44ekBb7oPrr4f"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"在制作幻燈片時(shí),用戶通常不清楚使用什么樣的圖片比較合適,其實(shí)圖片的選擇也有技巧。選擇合適的圖片不僅能在內(nèi)容上契合主題,也會(huì)使頁(yè)面更美觀。下面就介紹在選擇圖片時(shí)需要注意的幾點(diǎn)問(wèn)題:","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnicIiE4MeIew06pVGoxFmme"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"一、選擇高清的圖片","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnWI66K0wmSkWEW2JMrAOp8g"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"高清的圖片能給人視覺(jué)上的享受,如果圖片模糊不清,不僅看起來(lái)很粗糙,而且容易使觀眾產(chǎn)生視覺(jué)疲勞。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnWOMk4cOQAoG2YrGyNYjEGh"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":601,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"圖片選擇方法","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/65e757ac69854441bd0d1eed79e1413c","width":975},"text":"","id":"doxcnA2wKweqA0EUQ0UzFlCXWtc"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"二、選擇與內(nèi)容相關(guān)的圖片","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnaOwGwK6wk0ci0QieI0qfFg"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"在制作PPT時(shí),要選擇和幻燈片中內(nèi)容相關(guān)的圖片,或與主題相關(guān)的圖片,這樣便于觀眾的理解。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnWQ4AeKwwEiqAeWd04tAOpg"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":608,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"圖片選擇方法","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/f6e65506900b452a938d4a2e72036a2d","width":1028},"text":"","id":"doxcnQgIUCymo82mGeiF4MOeIjf"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"三、選擇與PPT風(fēng)格相關(guān)的圖片","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnI4MiiaagwiWQURQmH6YJOh"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"除了注意以上兩點(diǎn)以外,用戶還要注意選擇的圖片是否符合當(dāng)前PPT的風(fēng)格。PPT可分為以下4種風(fēng)格。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnE2gIgKmAKigmIdZJtc1YLh"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"1、嚴(yán)肅沉穩(wěn)。","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"此類風(fēng)格的PPT,大多以寫實(shí)圖片為主,并且細(xì)節(jié)豐富,光影變化細(xì)膩,給人一種沉穩(wěn)、可信感。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcneEyC4iKoIiqgyAXTCBTEwg"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":604,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"圖片選擇方法","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/4f98cadfb19746d694f885276d628f78","width":806},"text":"","id":"doxcnWU6WMMiASq8IQP0loMYyGc"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"2、輕松幽默。","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"此類風(fēng)格的PPT,主要以搞怪的表情或動(dòng)作圖片為主,這樣可以增加幻燈片的趣味性。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnqkkWGUswU4cycNiDbkOEb6"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":611,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"圖片選擇方法","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/3cc89cca796845d0bb8a87a6c66546a3","width":1056},"text":"","id":"doxcnKkK6Io6cOCaITyzudml6ph"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"3、詩(shī)情畫意。","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"此類型的PPT沒(méi)有明確的主題,主要以浪漫、清新或懷舊類圖片為主,以渲染主題氣氛。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnakEWQwKyqKOs4k18fIa9Kd"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":680,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"圖片選擇方法","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/bafd85d627464ab18d9e66f993c76e73","width":1119},"text":"","id":"doxcnoiMe0W8UGqSWKUotBeeG8d"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"4、另類獨(dú)特。","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"此類PPT一般都以創(chuàng)意性很強(qiáng)的圖片或者以繪制的圖案為主,也可以兩者結(jié)合,給人","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"獨(dú)樹一幟","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"的感覺(jué)。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcn4q2GAUm8e40McxXV1cI2Lh"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":714,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"圖片選擇方法","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/0dc62dd4c3734e0a98e3719536dd5461","width":962},"text":"","id":"doxcnUAIgySY8eyuQEFptj5wALb"},{"type":"heading","attrs":{"level":2},"children":[{"type":"text","text":"好圖片的搜索方法","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnAuc0iekWCkWO2B0NGmxqde"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"有人說(shuō)使用“百度”搜索到的圖片其質(zhì)量參差不齊,不好挑選。其實(shí)不然,有這種想法的人是因?yàn)樗麄儧](méi)有找對(duì)方法。下面就向用戶推薦幾種搜索圖片的方法。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcngSMeAymS8iiUQlndQr2Ouf"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"一、提煉搜索關(guān)鍵字。","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"輸入關(guān)鍵字即可。例如搜索“時(shí)間飛逝”類的圖片,輸入“時(shí)間”關(guān)鍵字。而如果輸入“時(shí)間匆匆”關(guān)鍵字后,搜索的結(jié)果就大相徑庭。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnwU4M88MWcG2Mm4zMC1osZg"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"二、組合詞搜索法。","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"有時(shí)候單憑一個(gè)關(guān)鍵詞搜索出來(lái)的圖片范圍太廣,想要從中找到符合的圖片很費(fèi)勁,這時(shí)可以試著將幾個(gè)關(guān)鍵詞組合在一起進(jìn)行搜索,限制搜索條件,這樣搜索出來(lái)的圖片會(huì)更精準(zhǔn)一些。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnWaaouyYoIwYs4Lud0IScmf"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"三、聯(lián)想詞搜索法。","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"有時(shí)使用關(guān)鍵詞和組合詞都搜索不出滿意的圖片,尤其是搜索一些偏理念或概念化的內(nèi)容,很難找到對(duì)應(yīng)的圖片,這時(shí)可以嘗試聯(lián)想詞搜索。將抽象的概念具體化,這需要用戶發(fā)散思維來(lái)聯(lián)想。例如,想要尋找關(guān)于“探索”的圖片,則可以用“宇宙”關(guān)鍵字進(jìn)行搜索。用戶也可以搜索“望遠(yuǎn)”,對(duì)遠(yuǎn)方的未知,也能激發(fā)人們?nèi)ヌ剿鳌?#34;,"id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnoASKi4iooAgEMfDWcUzA7b"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"提示:圖片也有版權(quán),如果將圖片用于商業(yè)用途,則需要支付版權(quán)費(fèi),使用時(shí)需要謹(jǐn)慎。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnmKo0GiKSMOKaGOUfsEjeoc"},{"type":"heading","attrs":{"level":2},"children":[{"type":"text","text":"在文中插入圖片","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcngCiEI6e0eekUyIJx9ADxsc"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"一、插入本機(jī)圖片","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcn0qKiAqcmioaMAJtKFK7rOd"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"在制作幻燈片前,通常會(huì)先搜集相關(guān)圖片,將滿意的圖片保存在電腦中,然后在制作時(shí)將這些圖片插入到幻燈片中。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcniCUG4QSikYUk2rrde5mUTh"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步驟1:打開演示文稿,切換至“插入”選項(xiàng)卡,單擊“圖像”選項(xiàng)組中的“圖片”按鈕。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcngOQsEW0uWieyuM7jIr8dsC"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":1031,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"在文中插入圖片","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/83f0a684a16d4884a9997e6f9930b34a","width":1920},"text":"","id":"doxcnaWY8GAEouUiw2fGagdER3b"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步驟2:打開“插入圖片”對(duì)話框,在“桌面”找到保存的圖片,然后單擊“插入”按鈕。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnSU4IAsW4A6KGSC3YHoo87f"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":1027,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"在文中插入圖片","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/6beaa2f9175e485393c34a186fb0d18c","width":1920},"text":"","id":"doxcn0akQY02u6GIkuwUFA1cuEd"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步驟3:選中的圖片隨即被插入到幻燈片中。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnoyS8s82kYi8ec6hjAwKFWb"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":942,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"在文中插入圖片","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/0883b834cb7147568af79000ea7b6fde","width":1852},"text":"","id":"doxcnGqEMw8gse2wI6ptRKfbl2e"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步驟4:將光標(biāo)移至圖片右下角的控制點(diǎn)上,按住鼠標(biāo)左鍵不放,拖動(dòng)鼠標(biāo)調(diào)整圖片的大小。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnUyeaGUwU0K2YcEJJY3mtlB"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":1033,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"在文中插入圖片","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/80c5a148c9a54106a21e159d6f967d92","width":1920},"text":"","id":"doxcnEywkI8M22SiKi0UZPKkYee"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步驟5:將光標(biāo)置于圖片上方,按住鼠標(biāo)左鍵不放,拖動(dòng)鼠標(biāo)將其移至頁(yè)面合適位置。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnkgIamiSSOyeMwBe0KXhP8g"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":1027,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"在文中插入圖片","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/d5ab9c486a5f450aa839f89932bdb4e4","width":1920},"text":"","id":"doxcnmk4KW2kuaoOiYNoV8DI4Hb"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"二、插入屏幕截圖","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnKIq4cWgcU0G68TfFqqsQqb"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"用戶可以使用屏幕截圖功能,將在桌面上打開的網(wǎng)頁(yè)或其他內(nèi)容捕捉下來(lái)的圖片插入到幻燈片中,下面介紹具體的操作方法。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnqaAUkUM8Mc4mu0pYXjYsrd"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步驟1:選擇幻燈片,在“插入”選項(xiàng)卡中單擊“圖像”選項(xiàng)組中的“屏幕截圖”下拉按鈕,從列表中選擇“屏幕剪輯”選項(xiàng)。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnsMMSY2QmKMWyuiqnbNwpE4"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":1031,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"在文中插入圖片","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/2a30c15705594a81b8d1152d13ab86b7","width":1920},"text":"","id":"doxcnI8K8K6IEo2eCwXRmJpLc6d"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步驟2:屏幕隨即變?yōu)槟:隣顟B(tài),按住鼠標(biāo)左鍵不放,在打開的網(wǎng)頁(yè)上拖動(dòng)鼠標(biāo),截取所需的部分圖像,此時(shí)被選取的區(qū)域會(huì)變得清晰。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnqaeYmUEeYYA68AjoK8TXmc"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步驟3:選取完成后松開鼠標(biāo),此時(shí)選取的部分圖像就被插入到了幻燈片中,最后調(diào)整圖片的大小和位置即可。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnW2uWoc2Auk6UewI7Lr1Z2d"},{"type":"heading","attrs":{"level":2},"children":[{"type":"text","text":"修飾圖片","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnKWc2Qk6wgyGuSfIUpbSSAG"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"在圖片插入到幻燈片后,用戶還可以對(duì)其進(jìn)行各種設(shè)置,例如更改圖片的顏色、樣式、外觀,或裁剪圖片等,使圖片更加契合幻燈片頁(yè)面。下面將分別對(duì)其進(jìn)行詳細(xì)介紹。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcncUm4g8wo4wgKO8UdiwppYf"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"一、更改圖片的顏色","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcn2eCEsgCkGQcEohcP3Gquhd"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"如果用戶對(duì)圖片的顏色不滿意,可以對(duì)其進(jìn)行更改。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcn4mUMsCYq8eq4E9r54e1Wch"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步驟1:選擇圖片,切換至“圖片工具-格式”選項(xiàng)卡,單擊“顏色”下拉按鈕。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnQG2kUWwSia2ash9xcVOOk1"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":1030,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"修飾圖片","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/5b079a7044d04857b7d3f8f679a7e265","width":1920},"text":"","id":"doxcneAKMUOcmKwSkEyMOASbZhb"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步驟2:在展開列表的“色調(diào)”區(qū)域,選擇“色溫:8800K”選項(xiàng),可以看到選中的圖片已經(jīng)被修改為相應(yīng)的顏色。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcneAG4yCOcSKc08L54Q7iwQd"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":1034,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"修飾圖片","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/769824bd50d742f8ba0d793594d5c82d","width":1919},"text":"","id":"doxcnYUWOCiwGmu6SSy3OIFyqye"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"二、更改圖片的亮度/對(duì)比度","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnW48qE2yU84CmCIGQETeKzb"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"用戶可以根據(jù)需要調(diào)整圖片的亮度與對(duì)比度。下面以將圖片更改為“亮度:+40%對(duì)比度:-40%”為例,介紹具體的操作方法。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnAuyQkcGaAKg6E9DNujKPle"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步驟1:選中圖片,在“圖片工具-格式”選項(xiàng)卡中單擊“校正”下拉按鈕。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcniA62cQcIkuaS0y3OZOwXTg"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":1030,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"修飾圖片","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/c5648557f4de45069aebf16eb73384ef","width":1920},"text":"","id":"doxcnEMIgo4SeOcE4CY0XedriMe"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步驟2:從展開的列表中選擇“亮度:+40%對(duì)比度:-40%”選項(xiàng),選中圖片的亮度和對(duì)比度隨即進(jìn)行相應(yīng)的調(diào)整。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnkGIuAweiocemiCm6nOTVWf"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":1037,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"修飾圖片","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/10ac0d7bce7f4514834c00537dc5ca99","width":1920},"text":"","id":"doxcnQGC6s46mqQwYGEjq7qwkqe"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"三、設(shè)置圖片的藝術(shù)效果","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnC6UYoISaqoUA0KJPApXFKd"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"用戶可以為圖片添加藝術(shù)效果,使圖片更具有藝術(shù)氣息。下面以為圖片添加“紋理化”藝術(shù)效果為例,介紹具體的操作方法。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnEiu4Yk48eQqmGS6QQCngxg"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步驟1:選中圖片,在“圖片工具-格式”選項(xiàng)卡中單擊“藝術(shù)效果”下拉按鈕。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnwOaeAec80aEKE36hlSKWKd"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":1030,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"修飾圖片","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/4afda3a9db564c9fa1c17cf96e78e3dc","width":1920},"text":"","id":"doxcnSqmA4uC28cWOesLQ9hKXFb"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步驟2:從展開的列表中選擇“蠟筆平滑”選項(xiàng),選中的圖片隨即應(yīng)用了該藝術(shù)效果。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnA8Iq0soSWYYqKYwYUzBCQc"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":1031,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"修飾圖片","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/8865fcbc8e4b475f8ee4b204f7d1cf6e","width":1920},"text":"","id":"doxcnmWWMaiIEMyueOYRu3Unsif"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"提示:","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"用戶可以在“藝術(shù)效果”下拉列表中選擇“藝術(shù)效果選項(xiàng)”選項(xiàng),打開“設(shè)置圖片格式”窗格,在“藝術(shù)效果”選項(xiàng)組中可以設(shè)置“透明度”和“縮放”選項(xiàng)來(lái)調(diào)整運(yùn)用的藝術(shù)效果。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnIkMoEsWSc6oO6cAcewfKTf"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"四、設(shè)置圖片樣式","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcn6Y4sIWeQMY666RCLRNOI2b"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"PPT內(nèi)置了很多圖片樣式,用戶可以根據(jù)需要設(shè)置相應(yīng)的圖片樣式。下面以將圖片的樣式設(shè)置為“簡(jiǎn)單框架,白色”為例,介紹具體的操作方法。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcny8gMWKk0iuCcyyqJPe2XNg"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步驟1:選擇圖片,在“圖片工具-格式”選項(xiàng)卡中單擊“快速樣式”按鈕。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnw8kCC4G8KccauO3am5Xvnb"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":1028,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"修飾圖片","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/bdc302d9605e4ff380665b677fbd7a56","width":1920},"text":"","id":"doxcnaiOowmu4wQkqUJoStrUmLg"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步驟2:從展開的列表中選擇“簡(jiǎn)單框架,白色”選項(xiàng),選中的圖片隨即應(yīng)用該樣式。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnE4iwok2cSa0Yk3bVfshgVb"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":1029,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"修飾圖片","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/762db9e95c0d4f0d9141e29334de00fb","width":1920},"text":"","id":"doxcn4gS2Ko8gmoWgKC6QoIh23b"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"五、對(duì)圖片進(jìn)行裁剪","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnimgUm8MWYe04F5Un4mbvFA"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"當(dāng)幻燈片中的圖片尺寸過(guò)大時(shí),為了不影響整體美觀,用戶可以對(duì)其進(jìn)行裁剪。下面以將圖片裁剪成“心形”為例,向用戶介紹圖片的裁剪操作。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnkSOKsC6MEaaGqOcFUPAMVd"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步驟1:選中需要裁剪的圖片,在“圖片工具-格式”選項(xiàng)卡中單擊“裁剪”下拉按鈕。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcn0OK8q24g0cEmCM0ktKnA4g"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":1031,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"修飾圖片","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/cf3cac3c802547e39145322e11104d50","width":1920},"text":"","id":"doxcnqE0ooSSWYckKEhELLze0ig"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步驟2:從展開的列表中選擇“裁剪為形狀”選項(xiàng),并從其級(jí)聯(lián)菜單中選擇合適的形狀,這里選擇“心形”選項(xiàng)。選中的圖片隨即被裁剪成心形。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcn6IW64k2MOWSYaye6LbErzf"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":1036,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"修飾圖片","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/95dc36ff7bbc45ddafe18f559b516033","width":1920},"text":"","id":"doxcnSscKMaqmuws0E09ibtnR5X"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"六、刪除圖片背景","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnWUOskAQmYSGO7xkQzx5EF1"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"PPT還具有一些簡(jiǎn)單的圖片處理功能,例如“摳圖”功能,即將圖片的背景刪除,下面介紹具體的操作方法。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnS2SGQIy86oc6SIE4AALkef"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步驟1:選中圖片,切換至“圖片工具-格式”選項(xiàng)卡,在“調(diào)整”選項(xiàng)組中單擊“刪除背景”按鈕。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcn8OIwA4ueGKyAfaUIQFocKl"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步驟2:功能區(qū)左側(cè)新增一個(gè)“背景消除”選項(xiàng)卡,圖片周圍出現(xiàn)8個(gè)控制點(diǎn),并且背景變?yōu)樽仙?#34;,"id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnWmSgMK4gicaEkj4tNE5Zjb"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步驟3:將光標(biāo)移到下方中間的控制點(diǎn)上,按住鼠標(biāo)左鍵向下拖動(dòng)鼠標(biāo),調(diào)整保留的區(qū)域。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnw2soY2m040sYs1Sz5DKZAg"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步驟4:若調(diào)整控制點(diǎn)后仍有一部分不在保留區(qū)域,則可以單擊“標(biāo)記要保留的區(qū)域”按鈕。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnEAIwCSQUW0S86XehRWB6Nc"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步驟5:鼠標(biāo)光標(biāo)變?yōu)楣P樣式,然后單擊鼠標(biāo)標(biāo)記要保留的區(qū)域。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnSU6o6gmaE8IAGA1CdJS1Jd"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步驟6:標(biāo)記完成后,單擊“保留更改”按鈕。可以看到圖片的背景已經(jīng)被刪除,只保留了主體部分。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnIMaCieuGm0wwYHSfXRmKod"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"提示:","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"若用戶需要?jiǎng)h除多余的標(biāo)記,則可以單擊“刪除標(biāo)記”按鈕,此時(shí)該按鈕處于選中狀態(tài),然后在多余的標(biāo)記上單擊鼠標(biāo)左鍵,即可將其刪除,刪除完成后再次單擊“刪除標(biāo)記”按鈕退出即可。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcngQcsEQSe6GIK4Utfh5SBve"},{"type":"heading","attrs":{"level":1},"children":[{"type":"text","text":"表格與圖表","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnC0YkO8GI4gkgUn5xKZmi2f"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"用戶在制作分析類演示文稿時(shí),可以使用表格來(lái)對(duì)數(shù)據(jù)進(jìn)行分析和管理,在幻燈片中插入表格的方法有多種,如插入固定行和列的表格、插入指定表格、插入Excel表格等,本節(jié)將對(duì)其進(jìn)行詳細(xì)介紹。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnGOo4GUokme4o4fQ5Z9byeh"},{"type":"heading","attrs":{"level":2},"children":[{"type":"text","text":"在PPT中插入表格","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnquWGQ8cca68IsVX5e2Ntid"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"一、插入固定行數(shù)、列數(shù)的表格","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnmsGeoQyEUEuuOQUMZA2pLc"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"在“表格”列表中滑動(dòng)鼠標(biāo),可以直接插入表格,但最多只能創(chuàng)建8行10列之內(nèi)的表格。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcn0KwkywCqEQimY4SWvEoXeI"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步驟1:選擇幻燈片,切換至“插入”選項(xiàng)卡,單擊“表格”下拉按鈕,在展開的列表中滑動(dòng)鼠標(biāo),選取8行10列的表格。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnC8aAsEoAQmUqa2Zj9hmuK4"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":1031,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"在PPT中插入表格","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/cc72b2d64eff418e85df8eb504dfcd65","width":1920},"text":"","id":"doxcnQMOQK2e4kKq4kBr1brKP3d"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步驟2:選取完成后單擊鼠標(biāo),即可插入。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcn0UIksWIWq4S8OwbSgtnhud"},{"type":"image","attrs":{"height":1027,"note":[{"type":"text","text":"在PPT中插入表格","id":""}],"url":"https://p3.douyinpic.com/large/tos-cn-i-qvj2lq49k0/8aa65294794d4e9db389fd1fc01c16fe","width":1920},"text":"","id":"doxcnUUaW4YY6OoSCczegOn6QSb"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步驟3:調(diào)整表格的大小和位置,然后在其中輸入數(shù)據(jù)即可。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnYQ2Wec8g8CqYWHZeG1aBJf"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"二、插入指定的表格","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnYYIQok6w8SeycTaNWr0SPd"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"如果第一種方法滿足不了需求,還可以通過(guò)對(duì)話框插入表格,具體操作方法如下:","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcn288qE2U6QQMg6q1kqoRqNf"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步驟1:選擇幻燈片,切換至“插入”選項(xiàng)卡,單擊“表格”下拉按鈕,從列表中選擇“插入表格”選項(xiàng)。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnMkQeq4kYEEmKG6dnQDUU9e"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步驟2:打開“插入表格”對(duì)話框,輸入“列數(shù)”和“行數(shù)”數(shù)值,單擊“確定”按鈕。幻燈片中隨即插入一個(gè)5列10行的表格。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnUMkO2kiEaSWCU8AyqVntpO"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步驟3:調(diào)整表格的大小和位置,輸入數(shù)據(jù)內(nèi)容即可。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnKiKMSw266sSicxjXTKa0Kg"},{"type":"heading","attrs":{"level":2},"children":[{"type":"text","text":"對(duì)表格進(jìn)行編輯","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcniUo0MCecWq8a6bQmw5KC2N"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"在插入表格后,用戶可以根據(jù)需要對(duì)表格進(jìn)行編輯,例如設(shè)置文本對(duì)齊方式、調(diào)整行高和列寬、拆分或合并單元格等,下面將分別對(duì)其進(jìn)行詳細(xì)介紹。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcn8koiMSG2MkyawDnQAxXs9f"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"一、設(shè)置文本對(duì)齊方式","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnAukeeCyKaOuEicly67DxNh"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步驟1:選中表格,切換至“表格工具-布局”選項(xiàng)卡,在“對(duì)齊方式”選項(xiàng)組中單擊“居中”按鈕。可以看到表格中的文本內(nèi)容已經(jīng)水平居中顯示。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcn0sOo0WSYMQ2seEwFYlNz3b"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步驟2:在“對(duì)齊方式”選項(xiàng)組中單擊“垂直居中”按鈕。可以看到表格中的文本內(nèi)容已經(jīng)垂直居中顯示。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcn4eaSkEqWgYmwI1Xirno37b"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"提示:","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"用戶也可以在“開始”選項(xiàng)卡中單擊“段落”選項(xiàng)組中的“居中”按鈕,將文本設(shè)置為水平居中。單擊“對(duì)齊文本”下拉按鈕,從列表中選擇“中部對(duì)齊”選項(xiàng),可以將文本設(shè)置為垂直居中顯示。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcngoqiQMM84QIkqqFhbdR8Pb"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"二、調(diào)整行高和列寬","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcngiySAA0cy0UaSazE4jIFNd"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"在表格中輸入數(shù)據(jù)后,因?yàn)閿?shù)據(jù)類型的差異,所以需要調(diào)整某行或某列的高度和寬度,使表格看起來(lái)更美觀、協(xié)調(diào)。下面將介紹表格行高和列寬的調(diào)整操作:","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnYO4ykSiqEquQovDiA2CRZd"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步驟1:調(diào)整列寬。將光標(biāo)移至需要調(diào)整列寬的列右側(cè)邊線上,光標(biāo)變?yōu)殡p箭頭形狀。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnGU8smyWMsiyc2VgoUyCI4b"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步驟2:按住鼠標(biāo)左鍵不放,拖動(dòng)鼠標(biāo),光標(biāo)下方出現(xiàn)一條虛線。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnAGYeIuIeWi86ioag0U8W6b"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步驟3:拖動(dòng)鼠標(biāo)將虛線移到合適位置后松開,可以調(diào)整列寬。按照同樣的方法,調(diào)整其他列的寬度。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnkGwSCe2GgYqwI37VisNsRc"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"三、拆分或合并單元格","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnsGOUGQUQQQoEOQ1HL8qo0g"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"為了使表格中的數(shù)據(jù)能夠合理分布,用戶需要對(duì)單元格進(jìn)行合并或拆分,下面介紹具體的操作方法:","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcncy48mCOm86coETDmJLRXJd"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步驟1:合并單元格。選中需要合并的單元格區(qū)域,切換至“表格工具-布局”選項(xiàng)卡,單擊“合并單元格”按鈕。選中的單元格區(qū)域隨即被合并成一個(gè)單元格。按照同樣的方法,合并其他單元格區(qū)域。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnCiogyO6yuCo4MXhAJJgYFd"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步驟3:拆分單元格。選中需要拆分的單元格,在“布局”選項(xiàng)卡中單擊“拆分單元格”按鈕。打開“拆分單元格”對(duì)話框,在“列數(shù)”和“行數(shù)”微調(diào)框中輸入數(shù)值,單擊“確定”按鈕。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnuAkc6mEkea6kYJLOUEoIIh"},{"type":"heading","attrs":{"level":2},"children":[{"type":"text","text":"對(duì)表格進(jìn)行美化","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnK60ig6Uu0uiQItdCDWaymf"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"在幻燈片中創(chuàng)建的表格是自帶表格樣式的。如果想要更改表格樣式,使其看起來(lái)更加美觀,則可以使用內(nèi)置樣式美化表格,或自定義表格樣式。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnmcKSu4MQ8wSI4cJMuZnXAb"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"一、使用表格內(nèi)置樣式","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnQaAsGs4GGMEcQB994bcVxb"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步驟1:選中表格,切換至“表格工具-設(shè)計(jì)”選項(xiàng)卡,單擊“表格樣式”選項(xiàng)組中的“其他”按鈕。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnYiAemMOiQoGuE0txY9M6MS"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步驟2:從展開的列表中選擇合適的表格樣式,可以選擇“中度樣式3-強(qiáng)調(diào)6”選項(xiàng),可以看到表格應(yīng)用了所選的樣式。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnq6IQQK4Si2UgK8vm88KNif"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"提示:","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"如果用戶想要清除應(yīng)用的表格樣式,則可以在“表格樣式”下拉列表中選擇“清除表格”選項(xiàng)即可。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcncwYksimY8GaKgttNW7K4Kc"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"二、自定義表格樣式","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnuaOKUMyE408iEJwODKCf7g"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"如果內(nèi)置的表格樣式無(wú)法滿足需求,則可以自定義表格樣式。例如,設(shè)置表格的邊框、底紋等,下面對(duì)其進(jìn)行詳細(xì)介紹。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcn0SysQEymGAIke0xmFXNbTd"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步驟1:選中表格,在“表格工具-設(shè)計(jì)”選項(xiàng)卡中單擊“繪制邊框”選項(xiàng)組中的“筆劃粗細(xì)”下拉按鈕。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcniGKK2KugQciWkHgl5qx7Qc"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步驟2:從展開的列表中選擇“3.0磅”選項(xiàng)。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnSCMYMu2EKQ04fc3ai1xADp"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步驟3:在“繪制邊框”選項(xiàng)組中單擊“筆顏色”下拉按鈕,從列表中選擇合適的顏色。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnmqOk08k2GAC4AZ5HNX0SNd"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"提示:","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"在幻燈片中,用戶還可以使用圖表來(lái)展示數(shù)據(jù),它使復(fù)雜的數(shù)據(jù)關(guān)系變得可視化、形象化,并且增強(qiáng)了幻燈片的感染力。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcny2iGEaqgemUey2pxnmfAOh"},{"type":"heading","attrs":{"level":2},"children":[{"type":"text","text":"圖表另類畫法","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnymaWu2uQqMKYuIECDyYIgc"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"如果用戶覺(jué)得創(chuàng)建的圖表千篇一律,不能引起觀眾的興趣,則可以在基礎(chǔ)圖表上增加一點(diǎn)創(chuàng)意,這樣圖表就能變得妙趣橫生,讓人眼前一亮。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnw2Mk8kg2CkEyMfhjkgwwyg"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"用戶可以使用圖片填充功能,制作出創(chuàng)意條形圖,下面介紹具體的操作步驟:","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnGWKAqQiwg2CmMXh67SlJIh"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步驟1:在“插入”選項(xiàng)卡中單擊“圖表”按鈕,打開“插入圖表”對(duì)話框,選擇“條形圖”選項(xiàng),并在右側(cè)選擇“簇狀條形圖”類型,單擊“確定”按鈕。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnicgIk44qaE6yQ5tzXgjBnc"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步驟2:在打開的Excel電子表格中輸入相關(guān)數(shù)據(jù),單擊“關(guān)閉”按鈕。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnKWoQ6suG6MYiQzK8mQSvew"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步驟3:幻燈片中隨即創(chuàng)建一個(gè)簇狀條形圖。選中條形圖,在“設(shè)計(jì)”選項(xiàng)卡中單擊“添加圖表元素”下拉按鈕,從列表中選擇“坐標(biāo)軸→主要橫坐標(biāo)軸”選項(xiàng),隱藏橫坐標(biāo)軸。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcn0Q4cae4ikuSis7N7WhBFcg"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步驟4:在“添加圖表元素”下拉列表中選擇“網(wǎng)格線→主軸主要垂直網(wǎng)格線”選項(xiàng),隱藏圖表的網(wǎng)格線。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnso2KmYaiEUeYmmJCGd08Df"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步驟5:選中垂直坐標(biāo)軸,單擊鼠標(biāo)右鍵,從彈出的快捷菜單中選擇“設(shè)置坐標(biāo)軸格式”命令。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnOwmuoo2640ssOSeb3nMe5d"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步驟6:彈出“設(shè)置坐標(biāo)軸格式”窗格,切換至“坐標(biāo)軸選項(xiàng)”選項(xiàng)卡,在“刻度線”選項(xiàng)組中單擊“主刻度線類型”右側(cè)的下拉按鈕,從列表中選擇“無(wú)”選項(xiàng)。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcn4e4GiCegCKI646a3lYBcxc"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步驟7:關(guān)閉窗格,查看設(shè)置的效果。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnkqusqMsQcucYOUPBoEcd2e"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步驟8:選中“步行”系列數(shù)據(jù)點(diǎn),單擊鼠標(biāo)右鍵,從彈出的快捷菜單中選擇“設(shè)置數(shù)據(jù)點(diǎn)格式”命令。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnkC0UOUWcCQaocZjTxvURhc"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步驟9:打開“設(shè)置數(shù)據(jù)點(diǎn)格式”窗格,切換至“填充與線條”選項(xiàng)卡,在“填充”組中選中“圖片或紋理填充”單選按鈕,然后單擊下方的“文件”按鈕。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnYC0M86iKGOcCSscAbG211c"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步驟10:打開“插入圖片”對(duì)話框,選擇合適的圖片,然后單擊“插入”按鈕。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcns0eWIaMGSG2cUpc3oPtbPd"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步驟11:此時(shí),可以看到圖片被填充到被選中的柱形中,但該圖片已嚴(yán)重變形。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnY6i0guM6y4Swq44CzkEUXg"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步驟12:再次打開“設(shè)置數(shù)據(jù)點(diǎn)格式”窗格,在“填充”選項(xiàng)組中選中“層疊”單選按鈕。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnyg2yUIQMekkQg9ZmyWCOwe"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步驟13:此時(shí),可以看到填充的圖片恢復(fù)到原來(lái)的比例。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnI88gIMm8WyKKCkNirnWIDb"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步驟14:按照同樣方法,填充其他系列數(shù)據(jù)點(diǎn),并刪除圖例,輸入圖表標(biāo)題,添加數(shù)據(jù)標(biāo)簽等。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcneMqG0OgwSiA8kTqsiiLnDh"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步驟15:選中圖表,在“格式”選項(xiàng)卡中單擊“形狀樣式”選項(xiàng)組中的“形狀填充”下拉按鈕,從列表中選擇合適的填充顏色。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnOMeUciWG8KumkxJsVePyxc"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"步驟16:查看設(shè)置好簇狀條形圖的最終效果。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnoKUIioQyC6uMOWQkvWKQCf"},{"type":"heading","attrs":{"level":1},"children":[{"type":"text","text":"添加音頻視頻","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcngeca0U8kcAImQX8jnCJSph"},{"type":"heading","attrs":{"level":2},"children":[{"type":"text","text":"聲音的插入與調(diào)整","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcn6a8I2sGQWoK6WQHYBYycAd"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"在制作演示文稿的過(guò)程中,特別是在制作商務(wù)方面的宣傳演示文稿時(shí),可以為幻燈片添加一些合適的聲音,添加的聲音可以配合圖文,使演示文稿變得有聲有色,更具感染力。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnkEKwksiEYEEIsr0womw8Bg"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"一、常見(jiàn)的音頻格式","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnMuI6cQ4cciOyqww0BuNkMc"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"PPT中常用WAV、MP3和MIDI等格式。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnOIeCygiEIAUwYZ3uM6yBNd"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"(1)WAV格式。WAV格式是Microsoft公司開發(fā)的一種聲音文件格式,用于保存Windows平臺(tái)的音頻信息資源,被Windows平臺(tái)及其應(yīng)用程序所支持,支持多種音頻位數(shù)、采樣頻率和聲道,是目前計(jì)算機(jī)上廣為流行的聲音文件格式,幾乎所有的音頻編輯軟件都識(shí)別WAV格式。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnOsASCMUyu0CmGQ11Z3C6Me"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"(2)MP3格式。MP3格式誕生于20世紀(jì)80年代的德國(guó),所謂的MP3是指MPEG標(biāo)準(zhǔn)中的音頻部分,也就是MPEG音頻層。MPEG音頻文件的壓縮是一種有損壓縮,犧牲了聲音文件中的12kHz~16kHz之間高音頻部分的質(zhì)量來(lái)壓縮文件的大小。相同時(shí)間的音樂(lè)文件,用MP3格式存儲(chǔ),一般只有WAV文件的1/10,而音質(zhì)要次于CD格式或WAV格式聲音文件。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnk8cm0GksomqactzmIYc6Nh"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"(3)MIDI格式。MIDI即音樂(lè)設(shè)備數(shù)字接口(MusicalInstrumentDigitalInterface)的英文縮寫,是20世紀(jì)80年代初為解決電聲樂(lè)器之間的通信問(wèn)題而提出的。MIDI傳輸?shù)牟皇锹曇粜盘?hào),而是音符、控制參數(shù)等指令、MIDI文件本身并不包含波形數(shù)據(jù),所以MIDI文件非常小巧,非常適合作為網(wǎng)頁(yè)的背景音樂(lè)。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnAOoaisKqeKKA62qgp59joh"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"二、添加各類聲音","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnOGqUmEQkwaaUW80QEH0KSb"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"添加文件中的聲音就是將計(jì)算機(jī)中已存在的聲音插人到演示文稿中,也可以從其他的聲音文件中添加用戶需要的聲音。具體方法如下:","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcns64kKAUwiQUiOkW2OBLAOb"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"(1)打開“XXX.pptx”,切換至“插入”面板,在“媒體”選項(xiàng)組中單擊“音頻”的下三角按鈕,在彈出的列表框中選擇“PC上的音頻”選項(xiàng)。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnECCiyGI4Q82Mg7En9k03de"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"(2)彈出“插入音頻”對(duì)話框,選擇素材文件夾下的“bgmusicl.mp3”聲音文件,單擊“插入”按鈕。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnQc4s4wQMs4S9tYXCEKswms"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"(3)執(zhí)行操作后,可以拖曳聲音圖標(biāo)至合適位置,按〈F5〉鍵后幻燈片播放,單擊播放按鈕就可以聽(tīng)到插入的聲音。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcni2WeIwUeaq2YWYhelkkYDe"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"(4)選擇音頻文件,執(zhí)行“音頻格式”→“播放”命令,打開“播放”面板,設(shè)置“開始”為“單擊時(shí)”,按〈F5〉鍵后幻燈片播放,音樂(lè)將自動(dòng)播放。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcn66wimCQYwMkwCUlE3mcsmc"},{"type":"heading","attrs":{"level":2},"children":[{"type":"text","text":"設(shè)置聲音屬性","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnCeWU04gC2GkSkgWj4XDqRD"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"打開PowerPoint,選擇需要插入的音頻文件,切換至“音頻格式”→“播放”面板,可設(shè)置音頻的相關(guān)播放屬性。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcn8uAyM6AK8Yyw8h2rXpFzIg"},{"type":"heading","attrs":{"level":2},"children":[{"type":"text","text":"添加視頻","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcn4AoAOI422aWuS2oMCAOhWd"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"PowerPoint2013中的視頻包括視頻和動(dòng)畫,可以在幻燈片中插入的視頻格式有十幾種,PowerPoint支持的視頻格式會(huì)隨著媒體播放器的不同而不同,用戶可從剪輯管理器或從外部文件添加視頻。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnmwGgimSkc4UKYBD6ZKbqdh"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"一、常見(jiàn)的視頻格式","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnqiGYEI08YmOew5VcbXrJze"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"PPT中常插入的視頻格式包括AVI、WMV、MPEG、MOV及SWF等。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnI0C0Cmc6IEu4crvtWSdSHb"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"(1)AVI格式。AVI格式即音頻視頻交錯(cuò)格式(AudioVideoInterleaved)的英文縮寫,是Microsoft公司開發(fā)的一種視頻文件格式。所謂音頻視頻交錯(cuò),是指可以將視頻和音頻交織在一起進(jìn)行同步播放。這種視頻格式的優(yōu)點(diǎn)是圖像質(zhì)量好,可以跨平臺(tái)使用;缺點(diǎn)是體積過(guò)于龐大,而且壓縮標(biāo)準(zhǔn)不統(tǒng)一,時(shí)常會(huì)出現(xiàn)視頻編碼原因而造成視頻不能播放等問(wèn)題。用戶如果遇到了這些問(wèn)題,可以通過(guò)下載相應(yīng)的解碼器來(lái)解決。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcn4ckou6IO8sMII1GBDYew0c"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"(2)MOV格式。MOV即QuickTime影片格式,它是Apple公司開發(fā)的一種音頻、視頻文件格式,用于存儲(chǔ)常用數(shù)字媒體類型。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcneASeSyYsgICWoV2w2P5mCe"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"(3)MPEG格式。MPEG即運(yùn)動(dòng)圖像專家組格式(MovingPictureExpertGroup)的英文縮寫,日常生活中用戶欣賞的VCD、DVD就是這種格式,今天常用的有MP4格式。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnOSKOo4uWy0gygPlylMT0Kg"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"(4)WMV格式。WMV即視窗媒體視頻(WindowsMediaVideo)的英文縮寫,是Microsoft公司推出的一種采用獨(dú)立編碼方式并且可以直接在網(wǎng)上實(shí)時(shí)觀看的視頻文件壓縮格式。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnUIMgeCkE4QWy8UN4fcXxOh"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"(5)SWF格式。SWF(ShockWaveFlash)是ADOBE公司的動(dòng)畫設(shè)計(jì)軟件Flash的專用格式,是一種支持矢量和點(diǎn)陣圖形的動(dòng)畫文件格式,被廣泛應(yīng)用于網(wǎng)頁(yè)設(shè)計(jì)、動(dòng)畫制作等領(lǐng)域,SWF文件通常也被稱為Flash文件。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnOIeG4MCC2oYyqcxNsYoPkg"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"二、添加文件中的視頻","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnUCYsUckgIyOaYVVAiUPHwd"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"添加文件中的視頻就是將計(jì)算機(jī)中已存在的視頻插人到演示文稿中。具體方法如下:","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnWUkuK8UaCkUe8dQWiv0b5c"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"(1)打開“視頻的使用.pptx”文件,切換至“插入”面板,在“媒體”選項(xiàng)組中單擊“視頻”的下三角按鈕,在彈出的列表框中選擇“PC上的視頻”選項(xiàng)。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcn0S0AI6MKOWyqesqbBCnyxc"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"(2)彈出“插入視頻”對(duì)話框,選擇素材文件夾下的“視頻樣例.wmv”聲音文件,單擊“插人”按鈕。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnwg4cUMo8SisYMJsD23pUCf"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"(3)執(zhí)行操作后,可以拖曳聲音圖標(biāo)至合適位置,按〈FS〉鍵后幻燈片播放,單擊播放按鈕即可播放視頻。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnSucisuC2mqsC6ilVtSwUHh"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"三、設(shè)置視頻屬性","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnkM0ymeeoakWSujzu1A7X2z"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"在幻燈片中選中插入的視頻,切換至“播放”面板,其中“視頻選項(xiàng)”選項(xiàng)組中的各頁(yè)與“音頻”選項(xiàng)組中的各選項(xiàng)作用類似,用戶可根據(jù)需要設(shè)置各選項(xiàng)。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnqAMm2SM0WO2uyi2t44gqEe"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"打開PowerPoint2013,選擇需要插入的視頻文件,切換至“視頻工具”→“格式”,可設(shè)置視頻的相關(guān)格式屬性。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnwOSMEwYKuaiSKODadL0tUc"},{"type":"heading","attrs":{"level":1},"children":[{"type":"text","text":"動(dòng)畫設(shè)置方法","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnCMIGE68ue6K88nRY4ZyDdf"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"人類對(duì)運(yùn)動(dòng)與變化具有天生的敏感。不管這個(gè)運(yùn)動(dòng)有多么微不足道,變化多么微小,都會(huì)強(qiáng)烈地抓住人們的視線。PPT動(dòng)畫的根本在于因內(nèi)容而變化。對(duì)內(nèi)容的表現(xiàn)力越強(qiáng),動(dòng)畫效果就越成功。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnmkKsqIYqq6i2yE7P8wcuVh"},{"type":"heading","attrs":{"level":2},"children":[{"type":"text","text":"動(dòng)畫的分類","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnyyS0u2EGQWuCiE9y7tOAkf"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"在PowerPoint中,所謂動(dòng)畫效果主要分為進(jìn)入動(dòng)畫、強(qiáng)調(diào)動(dòng)畫、退出動(dòng)畫和動(dòng)作路徑動(dòng)畫四類,此外,還包括幻燈片切換動(dòng)畫,從而實(shí)現(xiàn)了用戶對(duì)幻燈片中的文本、圖形、表格等對(duì)象添加不同的動(dòng)畫效果。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcng4A8OaoKGGK0iE9VhbHetd"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"一、進(jìn)入動(dòng)畫。","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"進(jìn)入動(dòng)畫是對(duì)象從“無(wú)”到“有”。在觸發(fā)動(dòng)畫之前,被設(shè)置為“進(jìn)人”動(dòng)畫的對(duì)象是不出現(xiàn)的,在觸發(fā)之后,那它或它們采用何種方式出現(xiàn),就是“進(jìn)入”動(dòng)畫要解決的問(wèn)題。比如設(shè)置對(duì)象為“進(jìn)入”動(dòng)畫中的“擦除”效果,可以實(shí)現(xiàn)對(duì)象從某--方向一點(diǎn)點(diǎn)地出現(xiàn)的效果。進(jìn)入動(dòng)畫PPT中一般都是使用綠色圖標(biāo)標(biāo)識(shí)。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnyoKakOoe0CKOEfTmpOU7nf"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"二、強(qiáng)調(diào)動(dòng)畫。","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"強(qiáng)調(diào)動(dòng)畫是對(duì)象從“有”到“有”,前面的“有”是對(duì)象的初始狀態(tài),后面的“有”是對(duì)象的變化狀態(tài)。兩個(gè)狀態(tài)的變化,起到了對(duì)對(duì)象強(qiáng)調(diào)突出的目的。比如設(shè)置對(duì)象為“強(qiáng)調(diào)動(dòng)畫”中的“變大/變小”效果,可以實(shí)現(xiàn)對(duì)象從小到大(或設(shè)置從大到小)的變化過(guò)程,從而產(chǎn)生強(qiáng)調(diào)的效果。進(jìn)入動(dòng)畫PPT中一般都是使用黃色圖標(biāo)標(biāo)識(shí)。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnek4Kwk4giEsq8cMZvgVlNb"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"三、退出動(dòng)畫。","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"退出動(dòng)畫與進(jìn)入動(dòng)畫正好相反,它可以使對(duì)象從“有”到“無(wú)”。觸發(fā)后的動(dòng)畫效果與“進(jìn)入”效果正好相反,對(duì)象在沒(méi)有觸發(fā)動(dòng)畫之前,是存在屏幕上,而當(dāng)其被觸發(fā)后,則從屏幕上以某種設(shè)定的效果消失。如設(shè)置對(duì)象為退出動(dòng)畫中的“切出”效果,則對(duì)象在觸發(fā)后會(huì)逐漸地從屏幕上某處切出,從而消失在屏幕上。退出動(dòng)畫PPT中一般都是使用紅色圖標(biāo)標(biāo)識(shí)。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnoYiIOKA0IKKq0yZ1SANbAy"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"四、動(dòng)作路徑動(dòng)畫。","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"就是對(duì)象沿著某條路徑運(yùn)動(dòng)的動(dòng)畫,在PPT中也可以制作出同樣的效果,就是將對(duì)象設(shè)置成“動(dòng)作路徑”效果。比如設(shè)置對(duì)象為“動(dòng)作路徑”中的“向右”效果,則對(duì)象在觸發(fā)后會(huì)沿著設(shè)定的方向線移動(dòng)。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcn822mK8e8ugAoGuYZsPPtAc"},{"type":"heading","attrs":{"level":2},"children":[{"type":"text","text":"動(dòng)畫的操控方法","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcne2IMu2kSa0kQyILxmGXjEh"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"選擇設(shè)置動(dòng)畫的對(duì)象,在“動(dòng)畫窗格”中,選擇一個(gè)動(dòng)畫,單擊右邊的下拉箭頭,彈出的下拉菜單。單擊“計(jì)時(shí)”選項(xiàng)中的“開始”按鈕,會(huì)彈出下拉列表框。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnMWqEg4cgOWWmGOQLvBeR3g"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"一、單擊開始。","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"只有在多單擊一次鼠標(biāo)之后該動(dòng)畫才會(huì)出現(xiàn)。例如想要讓兩個(gè)對(duì)象逐一順序顯示,單擊一次出現(xiàn)一個(gè),再單擊一次再出現(xiàn)一個(gè),那么兩個(gè)出現(xiàn)動(dòng)作都應(yīng)該選擇“單擊開始”動(dòng)作選項(xiàng)。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcneEQKGOSGy620LL2hObcYt6"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"二、從上一項(xiàng)開始。","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"該動(dòng)作會(huì)和上一個(gè)動(dòng)作同時(shí)開始。例如把第一個(gè)對(duì)象設(shè)置為“單擊開始”,第二個(gè)對(duì)象設(shè)置為“從上一項(xiàng)開始”,那么單擊一次之后,兩個(gè)對(duì)象的動(dòng)畫會(huì)同時(shí)進(jìn)行。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcn04AMYo0YW6M0h8t4yAlKFk"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"三、從上一項(xiàng)之后開始。","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"上一動(dòng)畫執(zhí)行完之后該動(dòng)作就會(huì)自動(dòng)執(zhí)行。對(duì)于兩個(gè)對(duì)象,如果第二個(gè)對(duì)象選擇了這個(gè)選項(xiàng),那么只需單擊一次,兩個(gè)對(duì)象的動(dòng)畫就會(huì)先后逐一進(jìn)行。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnQ6uM4wmUEWIiwjEPpXzG0b"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"四、效果選項(xiàng)。","id":""},{"type":"text","text":"單擊會(huì)打開“效果”選項(xiàng)卡。在這里,可以對(duì)動(dòng)作的屬性進(jìn)行調(diào)整。對(duì)于不同的動(dòng)作,此選項(xiàng)卡的內(nèi)容會(huì)有些差別。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnU6qaAyqYQak4OIoym4kCRb"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","marks":[{"type":"strong"}],"text":"最后是給各位職場(chǎng)人士的提示,千萬(wàn)不要為了追求PPT的美觀而忽略了其內(nèi)容的重要性,建議在掌握PPT設(shè)計(jì)技能前,將重點(diǎn)放在內(nèi)容表達(dá)上,利用常規(guī)的PPT操作做出滿足職場(chǎng)要求的作品才是正道。","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcnuM6oCGMOqy2mSc6tJPL7cd"},{"type":"paragraph","children":[{"type":"text","text":"","id":""}],"text":"","id":"doxcni24qeo44OA2sueJhxJhU6g"}]%3C%2Fhowto_content%3E 8. 我的世界電腦版nei怎么用按E打開背包后右邊的一堆物品應(yīng)該是NEI或TMI內(nèi)置修改器,可以按O隱藏,也可以打開背包后點(diǎn)左下角的“設(shè)置”按鈕,在里面關(guān)閉,還可以從那里將模式改為合成表模式,點(diǎn)一下背包右邊物品欄的物品就有合成表出來(lái),關(guān)于RPG mod我不是很清楚 9. 我的世界 NEI使用高純水晶可以起到增產(chǎn)的作用,并且可以進(jìn)行一些僅有高純水晶方能進(jìn)行的合成。 需要先做種子,一個(gè)沙子一個(gè)石英粉(福魯伊克斯粉)做兩個(gè)種子。有三種種子。 然后將他們泡在水里。注意,在beta8及以后的版本中,他們不會(huì)被掃地大媽掃走= = 為了加速種子生長(zhǎng),我們需要晶體催生器。合成很簡(jiǎn)單,請(qǐng)自行NEI。這里可能是最后一次提醒大家使用NEI了。(你非要G當(dāng)我沒(méi)說(shuō) 給它通能量(頂?shù)變擅婢桑鼤?huì)給四周的水方塊中的種子加速生長(zhǎng)。通電后會(huì)有閃爍效果出現(xiàn)。 為了達(dá)到最大加速效率,你可以多放幾個(gè)。 所有普通水晶可以進(jìn)行的合成,高純水晶均能替代。一個(gè)水晶磨兩個(gè)粉,合成兩個(gè)種子,得到兩個(gè)高純,于是高純水晶的制造過(guò)程完成了ae礦物的二倍增產(chǎn) 《我的世界》正是內(nèi)心最純真的你所可以天馬行空、無(wú)憂無(wú)慮幻想的地方,或許這才是一個(gè)游戲最成功的地方。 |
溫馨提示:喜歡本站的話,請(qǐng)收藏一下本站!